blob: 19f180884f1c1539501229733f343f26b6a753c4 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau080347f2021-05-01 08:25:15 +02007 2021/05/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200749In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
750regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
751only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
752
753* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
754
755* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
756 starting at one.
757
758* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
759 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
760 first section.
761
762These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
763if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
764section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
765"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
766proxies.
767
768This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
769logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
770to name some config objects like servers for example.
771
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200772See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200773
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100774
7752.4. Conditional blocks
776-----------------------
777
778It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
779some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
780ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
781configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
782versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
783preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
784text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
785lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
786switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
787are defined to form conditional blocks:
788
789 - .if <condition>
790 - .elif <condition>
791 - .else
792 - .endif
793
794The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
795as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
796matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
797there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
798only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
799".elif" of a block.
800
801Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
802ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
803as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
804
805The conditions are currently limited to:
806
807 - an empty string, always returns "false"
808 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
809 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200810 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
811
812The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
813
814 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
815 exists, regardless of its contents
816
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200817 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
818 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
819 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
820
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200821 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
822 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
823
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200824 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
825 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
826 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
827 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
828
829 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
830 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
831 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
832 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
833
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200834Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100835
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
837 listen mwcli_px
838 bind :1111
839 ...
840 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100841
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200842 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
843 bind :80
844 .endif
845
846 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200847 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200848 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200849 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200850 .endif
851
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200852 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
853 profiling.memory on
854 .endif
855
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200856Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100857
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200858 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100859 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
860 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
861 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
862
863Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
864"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
865fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
866provide advice to the user.
867
868Example:
869
870 .if "${A}"
871 .if "${B}"
872 .notice "A=1, B=1"
873 .elif "${C}"
874 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
875 .elif "${D}"
876 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
877 .else
878 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
879 .endif
880 .else
881 .notice "A=0"
882 .endif
883
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200884 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
885 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
886
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100887
8882.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200889----------------
890
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100891Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100892values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
893otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
894numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
895for every keyword. Supported units are :
896
897 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
898 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
899 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
900 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
901 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
902 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
903
904
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009052.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200906-------------
907
908 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
909 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
910 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
911 global
912 daemon
913 maxconn 256
914
915 defaults
916 mode http
917 timeout connect 5000ms
918 timeout client 50000ms
919 timeout server 50000ms
920
921 frontend http-in
922 bind *:80
923 default_backend servers
924
925 backend servers
926 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
927
928
929 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
930 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
931 global
932 daemon
933 maxconn 256
934
935 defaults
936 mode http
937 timeout connect 5000ms
938 timeout client 50000ms
939 timeout server 50000ms
940
941 listen http-in
942 bind *:80
943 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
944
945
946Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
947
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100948 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200949
950
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009513. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952--------------------
953
954Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
955are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
956of them have command-line equivalents.
957
958The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
959
960 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200961 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200962 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200963 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200964 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200965 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200966 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200967 - description
968 - deviceatlas-json-file
969 - deviceatlas-log-level
970 - deviceatlas-separator
971 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200972 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900973 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200974 - gid
975 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100976 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200977 - h1-case-adjust
978 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100979 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100980 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100981 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200982 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200983 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200984 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100985 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200986 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100987 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100988 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200989 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200990 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200991 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200992 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +0100993 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200994 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200995 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100996 - presetenv
997 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - uid
999 - ulimit-n
1000 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001001 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001002 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001003 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001004 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001005 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001006 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001007 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001008 - ssl-default-bind-options
1009 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001010 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001011 - ssl-default-server-options
1012 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001013 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001014 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001015 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001016 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001017 - 51degrees-data-file
1018 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001019 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001020 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001021 - wurfl-data-file
1022 - wurfl-information-list
1023 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001024 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001025 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001026
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001027 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001028 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001029 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001031 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001032 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001033 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001034 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001035 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001036 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001037 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001038 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001039 - noepoll
1040 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001041 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001042 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001043 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001044 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001045 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001046 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001047 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001048 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001049 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001050 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001051 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001052 - tune.buffers.limit
1053 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001054 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001055 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001056 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001057 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001058 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001059 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001060 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001061 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001062 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001063 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001064 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001065 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001066 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001067 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001068 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1069 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001070 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001071 - tune.maxaccept
1072 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001073 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001074 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001075 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001076 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1077 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001078 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1079 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001080 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001081 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001082 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001083 - tune.sndbuf.client
1084 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001085 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001086 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001087 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001088 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001089 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001090 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001091 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001092 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001093 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001094 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001095 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1096 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1097 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001098 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1099 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001100
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001101 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001102 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001103 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001104
1105
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011063.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001107------------------------------------
1108
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001109ca-base <dir>
1110 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001111 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1112 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1113 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001114
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001115chroot <jail dir>
1116 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1117 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1118 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1119 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1120 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001121 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001122
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001123cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1124 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1125 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1126 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1127 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1128 set. These sets have the format
1129
1130 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1131
1132 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001133 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001134 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1135 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001136 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1137 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001138 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1139 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1140 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1141 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1142 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1143 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1144 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1145 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1146 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1147 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001148
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001149 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1150 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1151 on the machine's word size.
1152
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001153 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001154 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1155 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1156 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1157 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1158 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1159 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001160
1161 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001162 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1163
1164 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1165 # first 4 CPUs
1166
1167 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1168 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1169 # word size.
1170
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001171 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001172 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001173 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1174 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1175 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1176
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001177 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1178 # and so on.
1179 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1180 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1181 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1182
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001183 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001184 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1185 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1186 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1187
1188 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1189 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1190 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1191
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001192 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1193 # and a thread range.
1194 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1195 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1196 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1197
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001198crt-base <dir>
1199 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001200 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1201 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001202
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001203daemon
1204 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1205 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001206 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1207 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001208
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001209default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
1210 By default haproxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
1211 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1212 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1213 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1214 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1215 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1216 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1217 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1218 not start with a slash ('/'):
1219 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1220 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1221
1222 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1223 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1224 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1225 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1226 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1227 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1228 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1229 each of them.
1230
1231 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1232 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1233 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1234 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1235 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1236 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1237 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1238 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1239
1240 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1241 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
1242 different haproxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
1243 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1244 made easily relocatable.
1245
1246 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1247 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1248 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1249 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1250 consistent across all configuration files.
1251
1252 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1253 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1254 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1255 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1256 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1257 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1258 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1259 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1260
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001261deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1262 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001263 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001264
1265deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001266 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001267 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1268
1269deviceatlas-separator <char>
1270 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1271 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1272
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001273deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001274 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1275 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1276 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001277
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001278expose-experimental-directives
1279 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1280 the config file will be rejected.
1281
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001282external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001283 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1284 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001285 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1286 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1287 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1288 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1289 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001290
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001291gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001292 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001293 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1294 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001295 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1296 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001297 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001298
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001299group <group name>
1300 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1301 See also "gid" and "user".
1302
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001303hard-stop-after <time>
1304 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1305
1306 Arguments :
1307 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1308 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1309 SIGUSR1 signal.
1310
1311 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1312 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1313 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1314
1315 Example:
1316 global
1317 hard-stop-after 30s
1318
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001319h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1320 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1321 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1322 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1323 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001324 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001325 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1326 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1327 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1328 specified in a proxy.
1329
1330 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1331 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1332 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1333 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1334 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1335 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1336 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1337
1338 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1339 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1340 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1341 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1342 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1343
1344 Example:
1345 global
1346 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1347
1348 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1349 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1350
1351h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1352 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1353 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1354 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1355 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1356 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1357 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1358 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1359 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1360
1361 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1362 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1363 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1364
1365 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1366 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1367
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001368insecure-fork-wanted
1369 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1370 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1371 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1372 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1373 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1374 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1375 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1376 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1377 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1378 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1379 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1380 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1381 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1382 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1383 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1384 disable it.
1385
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001386insecure-setuid-wanted
1387 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1388 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1389 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1390 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1391 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1392 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1393 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1394 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1395 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1396 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1397 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1398 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1399 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1400 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1401
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001402issuers-chain-path <dir>
1403 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1404 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1405 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1406 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1407 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1408 "issuers-chain-path".
1409 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1410 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1411 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1412 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1413 will share the chain in memory.
1414
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001415localpeer <name>
1416 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1417 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1418 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1419 the configuration parsing.
1420
1421 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1422 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1423
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001424log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001425 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001426 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001427 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001428 configured with "log global".
1429
1430 <address> can be one of:
1431
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001432 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001433 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1434 port).
1435
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001436 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1437 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1438 port).
1439
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001440 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001441 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1442 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001443 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001444
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001445 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1446 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1447 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1448 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1449 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1450 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1451 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1452 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1453 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1454 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1455 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1456 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1457 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1458 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001459 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1460 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001461
1462 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1463 "fd@2", see above.
1464
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001465 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1466 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1467 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1468 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1469 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1470
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001471 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1472 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001473
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001474 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1475 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1476 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1477 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1478 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1479 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1480 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1481 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1482 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1483 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001484 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1485 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001486
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001487 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1488 one of the following :
1489
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001490 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1491 field is stripped. This is the default.
1492 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1493 rfc3164.
1494
1495 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001496 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1497
1498 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1499 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1500
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001501 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1502 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1503 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1504 designed to be used with a local log server.
1505
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001506 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1507 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1508 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1509 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1510 logger consumes.
1511
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001512 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1513 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1514 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1515 used with a local log server.
1516
1517 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1518 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1519 designed to be used with a local log server.
1520
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001521 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1522 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1523 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1524 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1525
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001526 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1527 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1528 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1529 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1530 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1531
1532 <sample_size>
1533 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1534 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1535 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1536 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1537 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1538
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001539 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001540
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001541 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1542 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1543 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1544
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001545 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1546 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1547 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1548 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001549
1550 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001551 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1552 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1553 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1554 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1555 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1556 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001557
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001558 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001559
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001560log-send-hostname [<string>]
1561 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1562 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1563 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1564 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1565 the logs.
1566
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001567log-tag <string>
1568 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1569 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1570 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001571 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001572
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001573lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001574 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1575 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1576 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1577 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1578 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1579 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001580 used multiple times.
1581
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001582lua-load-per-thread <file>
1583 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1584 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1585 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1586 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1587 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1588 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1589 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1590 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1591 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1592 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1593 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1594 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1595 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1596 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1597 times.
1598
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001599lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1600 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1601 variable.
1602 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1603 to "path".
1604
1605 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1606 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1607 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1608 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1609 will be checked earlier.
1610
1611 As an example by specifying the following path:
1612
1613 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1614 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1615
1616 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1617 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1618 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1619 paths if that does not exist either.
1620
1621 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1622 documentation.
1623
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001624master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001625 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1626 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1627 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001628 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001629 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1630 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001631 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1632 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1633 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1634 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1635 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001636
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001637 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001638
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001639mworker-max-reloads <number>
1640 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001641 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001642 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1643 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1644 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1645
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001646nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001647 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1648 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1649 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001650 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1651 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001652 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1653 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1654 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001655
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001656nbthread <number>
1657 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001658 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1659 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1660 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1661 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1662 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001663 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1664 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1665 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1666 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1667 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1668 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1669 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001670
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001671numa-cpu-mapping
1672 By default, if running on Linux, haproxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
1673 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1674 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1675 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1676 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1677 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1678 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1679 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1680 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1681
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001682pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001683 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1684 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1685 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1686 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001687
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001688pp2-never-send-local
1689 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1690 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1691 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1692 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1693 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1694 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1695 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1696 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1697 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1698 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1699 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1700
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001701presetenv <name> <value>
1702 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1703 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1704 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1705 and "unsetenv".
1706
1707resetenv [<name> ...]
1708 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1709 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1710 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1711 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1712 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1713 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1714 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1715 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1716
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001717stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001718 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1719 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1720 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1721 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1722 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1723 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001724 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001725 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1726 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1727 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1728 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001729
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001730server-state-base <directory>
1731 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001732 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1733 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001734
1735server-state-file <file>
1736 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1737 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1738 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1739 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1740 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1741 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1742 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1743 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001744 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1745 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001746
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001747set-var <var-name> <expr>
1748 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1749 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1750 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1751 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1752 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1753 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1754 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1755 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1756 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1757
1758 Example:
1759 global
1760 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1761 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1762 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1763
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001764setenv <name> <value>
1765 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1766 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1767 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1768 and "unsetenv".
1769
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001770set-dumpable
1771 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001772 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1773 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1774 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1775 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1776 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1777 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1778 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1779 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1780 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1781 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1782 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1783 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1784 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1785 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1786 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1787 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1788 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001789
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001790ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1791 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1792 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001793 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001794 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001795 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1796 information and recommendations see e.g.
1797 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1798 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1799 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1800 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001801
1802ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1803 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1804 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1805 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1806 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1807 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001808 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1809 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1810 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001811 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001812
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001813ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1814 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1815 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1816 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1817 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1818 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1819
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001820ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1822 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1823 keyword to see available options.
1824
1825 Example:
1826 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001827 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001828
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001829ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1830 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1831 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001832 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001833 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001834 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1835 information and recommendations see e.g.
1836 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1837 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1838 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1839 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1840 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001841
1842ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1843 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1844 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1845 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1846 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1847 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001848 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1849 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1850 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1851 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001852
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001853ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1854 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1855 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1856 keyword to see available options.
1857
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001858ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1859 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1860 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1861 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001862 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001863 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001864 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1865 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1866 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1867 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001868 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1869 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1870 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1871
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001872ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1873 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1874 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001875 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001876 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001877 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1878
1879 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001880
1881 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1882 and won't try to remove them.
1883
1884 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1885
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001886ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001887 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001888 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1889 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001890
1891 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1892 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1893 optimize the startup time.
1894
1895 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1896 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1897 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1898
1899 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001900 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001901
1902 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001903 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1904
1905 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1906 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1907 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1908 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1909 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1910 bind configuration..
1911
1912 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1913 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1914 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1915 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1916 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1917 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1918 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1919 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1920
1921 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1922
1923 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1924 a cert bundle.
1925
1926 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1927 separately in several "crt".
1928
1929 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1930 since files are loading separately.
1931
1932 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1933 required to commit them.
1934
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001935 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001936 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001937
1938 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1939
1940 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1941
1942 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1943 not provided in the PEM file.
1944
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001945 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1946 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1947
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001948 The default behavior is "all".
1949
1950 Example:
1951 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1952 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1953 ssl-load-extra-files none
1954
1955 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1956
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001957ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1958 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1959 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1960 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1961
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001962ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001963 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001964 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1965 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1966 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1967 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1968 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1969 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001970 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001971
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001972stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1973 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1974 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1975 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001976 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001977 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001978
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001979 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1980 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1981 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001982
1983stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1984 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1985 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001986 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001987
1988stats maxconn <connections>
1989 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1990 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1991
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001992uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001993 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001994 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1995 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1996 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1997
1998ulimit-n <number>
1999 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2000 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2001 option.
2002
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002003unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2004 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2005
2006 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2007 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2008 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2009 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2010 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
2011 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
2012 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2013 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2014 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2015 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2016
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002017unsetenv [<name> ...]
2018 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2019 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2020 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2021 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2022 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2023 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2024 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2025
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002026user <user name>
2027 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2028 See also "uid" and "group".
2029
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002030node <name>
2031 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2032
2033 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2034 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2035 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2036 traffic.
2037
2038description <text>
2039 Add a text that describes the instance.
2040
2041 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2042 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2043 "<" and ">" characters.
2044
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100204551degrees-data-file <file path>
2046 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002047 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002048
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002049 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002050 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2051
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000205251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002053 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2054 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2055 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2056
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002057 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002058 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2059
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200206051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002061 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2062 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2063
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002064 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
2065 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2066
206751degrees-cache-size <number>
2068 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2069 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2070 By default, this cache is disabled.
2071
2072 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002073 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2074
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002075wurfl-data-file <file path>
2076 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2077 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2078
2079 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2080 with USE_WURFL=1.
2081
2082wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2083 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2084 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2085 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2086
2087 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2088
2089 Valid WURFL properties are:
2090 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2091
2092 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2093 device.
2094
2095 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2096 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2097
2098 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2099 particular web request.
2100
2101 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2102 used Libwurfl API version.
2103
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002104 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2105 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2106
2107 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2108 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2109
2110 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2111
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002112 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2113 with USE_WURFL=1.
2114
2115wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2116 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2117 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2118
2119 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2120 with USE_WURFL=1.
2121
2122wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2123 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2124 thus before the chroot.
2125
2126 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2127 with USE_WURFL=1.
2128
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002129wurfl-cache-size <size>
2130 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2131 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002132 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002133 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002134
2135 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
2136 with USE_WURFL=1.
2137
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002138strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002139 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
2140 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2141 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2142 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2143 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002144
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021453.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002146-----------------------
2147
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002148busy-polling
2149 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2150 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2151 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2152 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2153 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2154 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2155 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2156 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2157 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2158 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2159 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2160 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2161 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2162 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2163 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2164 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2165 "poll" pollers.
2166
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002167 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2168 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2169 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2170
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002171max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2172 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2173 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2174 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2175 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2176 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2177 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2178 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2179 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2180
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002181maxconn <number>
2182 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2183 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2184 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002185 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2186 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2187 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2188 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002189 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2190 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2191 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2192 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2193 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2194 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002195
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002196maxconnrate <number>
2197 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2198 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2199 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2200 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2201 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2202 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2203 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2204 fairness.
2205
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002206maxcomprate <number>
2207 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002208 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002209 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2210 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2211 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002212 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002213 default value.
2214
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002215maxcompcpuusage <number>
2216 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2217 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2218 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2219 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2220 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2221 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2222 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2223 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2224
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002225maxpipes <number>
2226 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2227 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2228 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2229 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2230 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2231 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2232
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002233maxsessrate <number>
2234 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2235 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2236 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2237 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2238 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2239 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2240 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2241 fairness.
2242
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002243maxsslconn <number>
2244 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2245 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2246 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2247 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2248 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2249 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2250 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002251 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2252 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2253 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2254 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2255 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2256 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2257 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002258
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002259maxsslrate <number>
2260 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2261 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2262 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2263 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2264 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2265 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2266 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2267 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2268 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2269 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2270
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002271maxzlibmem <number>
2272 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2273 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2274 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002275 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2276 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2277 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2278
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002279noepoll
2280 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2281 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002282 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002283
2284nokqueue
2285 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2286 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2287 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2288
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002289noevports
2290 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2291 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2292 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2293 also "nopoll".
2294
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002295nopoll
2296 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2297 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002298 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002299 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2300 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002301
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002302nosplice
2303 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002304 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002305 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002306 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002307 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2308 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2309 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2310 "option splice-response".
2311
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002312nogetaddrinfo
2313 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2314 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2315
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002316noreuseport
2317 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2318 command line argument "-dR".
2319
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002320profiling.memory { on | off }
2321 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2322 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2323 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2324 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2325 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2326 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2327 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2328 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2329 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2330
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002331profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2332 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2333 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2334 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2335 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002336 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002337 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2338 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2339 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2340 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2341
2342 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2343 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2344 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2345 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2346 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002347 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2348 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2349 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2350 CLI.
2351
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002352spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002353 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2354 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2355 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2356 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2357 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2358 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002360ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002361 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002362 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002363 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2364 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2365 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2366 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2367 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002368 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2369 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002370 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2371 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2372 openssl configuration file uses:
2373 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2374
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002375ssl-mode-async
2376 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002377 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002378 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2379 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2380 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002381 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002382 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002383
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002384tune.buffers.limit <number>
2385 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2386 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2387 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2388 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2389 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002390 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002391 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2392 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2393 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2394 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2395 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2396 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2397 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2398 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2399 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2400
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002401tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2402 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2403 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2404 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2405 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2406
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002407tune.bufsize <number>
2408 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2409 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2410 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2411 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2412 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2413 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2414 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002415 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2416 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2417 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002418 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002419 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2420 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2421 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002422
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002423tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2424 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002425
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002426tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2427 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2428 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2429 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2430 this value. The default value is 1.
2431
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002432tune.fail-alloc
2433 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2434 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2435 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2436 gracefully.
2437
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002438tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2439 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2440 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2441 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2442 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2443 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2444
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002445tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2446 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2447 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2448 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2449 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2450 change it.
2451
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002452tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2453 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002454 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2455 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002456 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2457 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2458 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2459 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2460 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2461
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002462tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2463 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2464 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2465 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2466 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2467 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2468 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2469 recommended not to change this value.
2470
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002471tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2472 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2473 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2474 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2475 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2476 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2477 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2478 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2479
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002480tune.http.cookielen <number>
2481 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2482 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2483 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2484 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2485 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2486 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2487 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2488 to change this value.
2489
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002490tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002491 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2492 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002493 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002494 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002495 configuration directives too.
2496 The default value is 1024.
2497
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002498tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2499 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2500 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2501 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2502 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2503 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2504 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002505 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2506 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2507 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002508
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002509tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2510 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2511 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2512 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2513 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2514 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2515 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002516 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2517 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2518 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2519 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2520 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002521
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002522tune.idletimer <timeout>
2523 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2524 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2525 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2526 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2527 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2528 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002529 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002530 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002531 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2532
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002533tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2534 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2535 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2536 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2537 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2538 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2539 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2540 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2541 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2542 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2543
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002544tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2545 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002546 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002547 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2548 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002549 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002550 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2551 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2552
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002553tune.lua.maxmem
2554 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2555 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2556 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2557 memory.
2558
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002559tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2560 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002561 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2562 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002563 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002564
2565tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2566 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2567 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2568 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2569 check servers.
2570
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002571tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2572 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2573 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2574 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002575 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002576
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002577tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002578 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2579 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002580 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2581 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2582 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2583 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2584 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2585 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2586 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2587 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2588 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002589
2590tune.maxpollevents <number>
2591 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2592 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2593 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2594 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2595 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2596
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002597tune.maxrewrite <number>
2598 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2599 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2600 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2601 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2602 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2603 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2604 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2605 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2606 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2607 bufsize.
2608
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002609tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2610 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2611 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2612 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2613 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2614 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2615 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2616 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2617 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2618 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002619 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2620 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002621 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2622 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2623 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2624 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2625 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2626 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2627 setting this parameter to 0.
2628
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002629tune.pipesize <number>
2630 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2631 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2632 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2633 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2634 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2635 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2636
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002637tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2638 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2639 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2640 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2641 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2642 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2643 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002644 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002645
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002646tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2647 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2648 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2649 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2650 default is 20.
2651
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002652tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2653tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2654 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2655 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2656 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002657 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002658 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002659 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2660 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2661
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002662tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002663 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002664 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2665 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2666 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2667 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2668
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002669tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002670 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002671 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2672 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2673 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2674 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2675 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2676 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2677 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002678
2679tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2680 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2681 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2682 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2683 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2684 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2685 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2686 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2687 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2688 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002689
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002690tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2691tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2692 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2693 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2694 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002695 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002696 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002697 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2698 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2699 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2700 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2701 notifying haproxy again.
2702
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002703tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002704 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002705 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2706 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2707 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2708 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2709 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2710 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2711 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2712 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2713 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2714 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2715 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002716
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002717tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002718 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002719 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2720 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2721 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2722 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2723 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2724
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002725tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2726 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2727 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2728 performances. This is disabled by default.
2729
2730 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2731 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2732
2733 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2734
2735 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2736
2737 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2738
2739 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2740 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2741 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2742
2743 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2744 converted.
2745
2746 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2747 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2748 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2749 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2750 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2751 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2752 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002753 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2754 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002755
2756 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2757
2758 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2759 only need this line:
2760
2761 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2762
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002763tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2764 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002765 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002766 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2767 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2768 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2769 being used for too long.
2770
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002771tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2772 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2773 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2774 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2775 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2776 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2777 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2778 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2779 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2780 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2781 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002782 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002783 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002784
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002785tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2786 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2787 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2788 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2789 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002790 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002791 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2792 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002793 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2794 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002795
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002796tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2797 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2798 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2799 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2800 1000 entries.
2801
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002802tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2803 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2804 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2805 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2806
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002807tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002808tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002809tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2810tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2811tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002812 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2813 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2814 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2815 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2816 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2817 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2818 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2819 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002820
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002821 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2822 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2823 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2824 all available space is consumed.
2825 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2826 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2827 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002828
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002829tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2830 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002831 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002832 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002833 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002834 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2835
2836tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2837 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2838 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002839 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2840 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002841
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028423.3. Debugging
2843--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002844
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002845quiet
2846 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2847 line argument "-q".
2848
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002849zero-warning
2850 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2851 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2852 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2853 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2854 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2855 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2856
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002857
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010028583.4. Userlists
2859--------------
2860It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2861http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2862it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2863
2864userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002865 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002866 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2867
2868group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002869 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002870 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2871 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2872
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002873user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2874 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002875 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2876 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002877 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2878 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2879 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2880 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002881
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002882 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2883 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2884 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2885 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2886 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2887 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2888 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2889 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2890 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002891
2892 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002893 userlist L1
2894 group G1 users tiger,scott
2895 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002896
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002897 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2898 user scott insecure-password elgato
2899 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002900
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002901 userlist L2
2902 group G1
2903 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002904
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002905 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2906 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2907 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002908
2909 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002910
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002911
29123.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002913----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002914It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2915several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2916instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2917values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2918automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2919In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2920using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2921tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2922reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2923Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2924that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2925each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002926
2927peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002928 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002929 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2930
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002931bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2932 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2933 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2934
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002935disabled
2936 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2937 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2938 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2939
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002940default-bind [param*]
2941 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2942
2943default-server [param*]
2944 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2945
2946 Arguments:
2947 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2948 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2949 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2950 details.
2951
2952
2953 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2954
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002955enable
2956 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2957
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002958log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002959 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2960 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2961 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2962 more details.
2963
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002964peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002965 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2966 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002967 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2968 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2969 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2970 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2971 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002972
2973 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2974 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2975
2976 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002977 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2978 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2979 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002980
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002981 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2982 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002983
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002984 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2985 "server" keyword explanation below).
2986
2987server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002988 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002989 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2990 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2991 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2992 of this "peers" section).
2993 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2994
2995
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002996 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002997 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002998 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002999 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3000 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3001 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003002
3003 backend mybackend
3004 mode tcp
3005 balance roundrobin
3006 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3007 stick on src
3008
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003009 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3010 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003011
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003012 Example:
3013 peers mypeers
3014 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3015 default-server ssl verify none
3016 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3017 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003018
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003019
3020table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3021 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3022
3023 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3024 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003025 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003026 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3027 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3028 "stick-table" keyword).
3029
3030 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3031 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3032 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3033 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3034 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3035 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3036 of the stick-table name as follows:
3037
3038 peers mypeers
3039 peer A ...
3040 peer B ...
3041 table t1 ...
3042
3043 frontend fe1
3044 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3045
3046 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3047 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3048
3049 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3050 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3051 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3052 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3053 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3054 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3055 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3056
3057 peers mypeers
3058 peer A ...
3059 peer B ...
3060 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3061
3062 backend t1
3063 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3064
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003065 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003066 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3067 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3068
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090030693.6. Mailers
3070------------
3071It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3072If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3073in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3074
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003075mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003076 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3077 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3078
3079mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3080 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3081
3082 Example:
3083 mailers mymailers
3084 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3085 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3086
3087 backend mybackend
3088 mode tcp
3089 balance roundrobin
3090
3091 email-alert mailers mymailers
3092 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3093 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3094
3095 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3096 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3097
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003098timeout mail <time>
3099 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3100 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3101 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3102 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3103
3104 Example:
3105 mailers mymailers
3106 timeout mail 20s
3107 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003108
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031093.7. Programs
3110-------------
3111In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3112master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3113managed the same way as the workers.
3114
3115During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3116sequence as a worker:
3117
3118 - the master is re-executed
3119 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3120 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3121 instance of the program
3122
3123During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3124
3125program <name>
3126 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3127 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3128 the management guide).
3129
3130command <command> [arguments*]
3131 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3132 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3133 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3134 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3135
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003136user <user name>
3137 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3138 See also "group".
3139
3140group <group name>
3141 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3142 See also "user".
3143
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003144option start-on-reload
3145no option start-on-reload
3146 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3147 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3148 program section.
3149
3150
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010031513.8. HTTP-errors
3152----------------
3153
3154It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3155imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3156several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3157
3158http-errors <name>
3159 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3160 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3161
3162errorfile <code> <file>
3163 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3164
3165 Arguments :
3166 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003167 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003168 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003169
3170 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3171 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3172 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3173 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3174 before any chroot is performed.
3175
3176 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3177
3178 Example:
3179 http-errors website-1
3180 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3181 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3182 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3183
3184 http-errors website-2
3185 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3186 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3187 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3188
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020031893.9. Rings
3190----------
3191
3192It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3193servers or traces.
3194
3195ring <ringname>
3196 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3197
3198description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003199 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003200 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3201
3202format <format>
3203 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3204
3205 Arguments:
3206 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3207 one of the following :
3208
3209 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3210 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3211 designed to be used with a local log server.
3212
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003213 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3214 field is stripped. This is the default.
3215 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3216 rfc3164.
3217
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003218 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3219 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3220 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3221 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3222 is the default.
3223
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003224 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003225 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3226
3227 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3228 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3229
3230 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3231 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3232 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3233 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3234 logger consumes.
3235
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003236 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3237 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3238 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3239 with a local log server.
3240
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003241 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3242 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3243 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3244 used with a local log server.
3245
3246maxlen <length>
3247 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3248 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3249 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3250
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003251server <name> <address> [param*]
3252 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3253 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3254 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3255 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3256 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3257 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3258 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3259 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3260 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003261 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3262 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003263
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003264size <size>
3265 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3266 set to BUFSIZE.
3267
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003268timeout connect <timeout>
3269 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3270
3271 Arguments :
3272 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3273 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3274 as explained at the top of this document.
3275
3276timeout server <timeout>
3277 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3278
3279 Arguments :
3280 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3281 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3282 as explained at the top of this document.
3283
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003284 Example:
3285 global
3286 log ring@myring local7
3287
3288 ring myring
3289 description "My local buffer"
3290 format rfc3164
3291 maxlen 1200
3292 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003293 timeout connect 5s
3294 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003295 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003296
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020032973.10. Log forwarding
3298-------------------
3299
3300It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3301haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3302
3303log-forward <name>
3304 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3305
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003306backlog <conns>
3307 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3308 on connections accept.
3309
3310bind <addr> [param*]
3311 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003312 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3313 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3314 syslog protocol over TCP.
3315 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003316 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3317
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003318dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003319 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3320 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3321 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3322 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003323 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003324
3325log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003326log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003327 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3328 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3329 documentation.
3330 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3331 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3332 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3333 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3334 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3335
3336 Example:
3337 global
3338 log stderr format iso local7
3339
3340 ring myring
3341 description "My local buffer"
3342 format rfc5424
3343 maxlen 1200
3344 size 32764
3345 timeout connect 5s
3346 timeout server 10s
3347 # syslog tcp server
3348 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3349
3350 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003351 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3352 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003353 # all messages on stderr
3354 log global
3355 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3356 log ring@myring local0
3357 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3358 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3359 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3360 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3361 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003362
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003363maxconn <conns>
3364 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3365 10 is the default.
3366
3367timeout client <timeout>
3368 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3369
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033704. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003371----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003372
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003373Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003374 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3375 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3376 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3377 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003378
3379A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3380connections.
3381
3382A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3383to forward incoming connections.
3384
3385A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3386parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3387
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003388A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3389ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3390sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3391the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3392explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3393from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3394"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3395for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3396to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3397optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3398are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3399any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3400names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3401that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3402duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3403names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3404
3405Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3406settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3407of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3408profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3409timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3410
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003411All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3412'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3413case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3414
3415Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3416logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3417proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3418However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3419name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3420
3421Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3422and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003423bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003424protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3425modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3426arbitrary criteria.
3427
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003428In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3429a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003430the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003431
3432 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3433 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3434 between responses and new requests.
3435
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003436 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3437 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3438 client-facing connection remains open.
3439
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003440 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3441 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003442
3443The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3444frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3445following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003446weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003447
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003448 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003449
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003450 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3451 ----+-----+-----+----
3452 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3453 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003454 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3455 ----+-----+-----+----
3456 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003457
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003458It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3459only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3460into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3461as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3462content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3463and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3464possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003465
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003466There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3467first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3468processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3469second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3470protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3471is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3472new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3473to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3474process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3475already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3476HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3477evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3478one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3479
3480There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3481performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3482tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3483preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3484analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3485HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3486header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3487mitigate this drawback.
3488
3489It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3490method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3491set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3492in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3493is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3494to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3495above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3496to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3497"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3498frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3499frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3500as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3501upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3502on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3503the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3504upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3505frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3506remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003507
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035084.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3509--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003510
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003511The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3512limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3513they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3514limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003515marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003516option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003517and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3518with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3519specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003520
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003521
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003522 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3523------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3524acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003525backlog X X X -
3526balance X - X X
3527bind - X X -
3528bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003529capture cookie - X X -
3530capture request header - X X -
3531capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003532clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3533clitcpka-idle X X X -
3534clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003535compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003536cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003537declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003538default-server X - X X
3539default_backend X X X -
3540description - X X X
3541disabled X X X X
3542dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003543email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003544email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003545email-alert mailers X X X X
3546email-alert myhostname X X X X
3547email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003548enabled X X X X
3549errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003550errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003551errorloc X X X X
3552errorloc302 X X X X
3553-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3554errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003555force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003556filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003557fullconn X - X X
3558grace X X X X
3559hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003560http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003561http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003562http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003563http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003564http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003565http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003566http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003567http-check set-var X - X X
3568http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003569http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003570http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003571http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003572http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003573http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003574id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003575ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003576load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003577log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003578log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003579log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003580log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003581max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003582maxconn X X X -
3583mode X X X X
3584monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003585monitor-uri X X X -
3586option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3587option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3588option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3589option allbackups (*) X - X X
3590option checkcache (*) X - X X
3591option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3592option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003593option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003594option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3595option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003596-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3597option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003598option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3599option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003600option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003601option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003602option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003603option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003604option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003605option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3606option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3607option httpchk X - X X
3608option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003609option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003610option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003611option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003612option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003613option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003614option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3615option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3616option logasap (*) X X X -
3617option mysql-check X - X X
3618option nolinger (*) X X X X
3619option originalto X X X X
3620option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003621option pgsql-check X - X X
3622option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003624option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003625option smtpchk X - X X
3626option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3627option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3628option splice-request (*) X X X X
3629option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003630option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3632option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3633-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003634option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003635option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3636option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3637option tcpka X X X X
3638option tcplog X X X X
3639option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003640external-check command X - X X
3641external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003642persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3643rate-limit sessions X X X -
3644redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003645-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003646retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003647retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003649server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003650server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003651source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003652srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3653srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3654srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003655stats admin - X X X
3656stats auth X X X X
3657stats enable X X X X
3658stats hide-version X X X X
3659stats http-request - X X X
3660stats realm X X X X
3661stats refresh X X X X
3662stats scope X X X X
3663stats show-desc X X X X
3664stats show-legends X X X X
3665stats show-node X X X X
3666stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003667-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3668stick match - - X X
3669stick on - - X X
3670stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003671stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003672stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003673tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003674tcp-check connect X - X X
3675tcp-check expect X - X X
3676tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003677tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003678tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003679tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003680tcp-check set-var X - X X
3681tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003682tcp-request connection - X X -
3683tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003684tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003685tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003686tcp-response content - - X X
3687tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003688timeout check X - X X
3689timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003690timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003691timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003692timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3693timeout http-request X X X X
3694timeout queue X - X X
3695timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003696timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003697timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003698timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003699transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003700unique-id-format X X X -
3701unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003703use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003704use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003705------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3706 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003707
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003708
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037094.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3710---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003711
3712This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3713
3714
3715acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3716 Declare or complete an access list.
3717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3718 no | yes | yes | yes
3719 Example:
3720 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3721 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3722 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003724 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003725
3726
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003727backlog <conns>
3728 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3730 yes | yes | yes | no
3731 Arguments :
3732 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3733 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003734 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003735
3736 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3737 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3738 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3739 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3740 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3741 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3742 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3743 backlog parameter.
3744
3745 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3746 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3747 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3748
3749 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3750
3751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003752balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003753balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003754 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3756 yes | no | yes | yes
3757 Arguments :
3758 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3759 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3760 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3761 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3762
3763 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3764 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3765 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3766 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003767 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003768 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003769 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3770 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3771 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3772 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3773 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3774 it, so that you don't worry.
3775
3776 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3777 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3778 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3779 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3780 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3781 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3782 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3783 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003784
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003785 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3786 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3787 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3788 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3789 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3790 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3791 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003792 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3793 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3794 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003795
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003796 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003797 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003798 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3799 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003800 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003801 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3802 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3803 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3804 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3805 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003806 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3807 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3808 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3809 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3810 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3811 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003813 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3814 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3815 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3816 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3817 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3818 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3819 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3820 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003821 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003822 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003823 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3824 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3825 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003826
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003827 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3828 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3829 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3830 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3831 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3832 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3833 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3834 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3835 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3836 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3837 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3838 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003839
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003840 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003841 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3842 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3843 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3844 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3845 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3846 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3847 URIs start with a leading "/".
3848
3849 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3850 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3851 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3852 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3853
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003854 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3855 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3856 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3857 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3858
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003859 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003860 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3861
3862 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003863 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3864 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003865 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3866 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3867 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3868 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003869 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003870 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3871 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003872
3873 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3874 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3875 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3876 server will receive the request.
3877
3878 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3879 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3880 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3881 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3882 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003883 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3884 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3885 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003886
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003887 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3888 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3889 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3890 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3891 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003892
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003893 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003894 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3895 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3896 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3897
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003898 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3899 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3900 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3901
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003902 random
3903 random(<draws>)
3904 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003905 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3906 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3907 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3908 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003909 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3910 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3911 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3912 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3913 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3914 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3915 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3916 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3917 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3918 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3919 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3920 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3921 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3922 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3923 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3924 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3925 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3926 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3927 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3928 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003929
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003930 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003931 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003932 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3933 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3934 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3935 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3936 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3937 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003938 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003939 used instead.
3940
3941 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3942 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3943 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3944 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3945
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003946 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3947 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3948 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3949
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003950 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003951
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003952 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003953 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3954 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003955
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003956 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3957 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3958 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003959
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003960 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003961 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003962 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3963 NTLM relies on.
3964
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003965 Examples :
3966 balance roundrobin
3967 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003968 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003969 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3970 balance hdr(host)
3971 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003972
3973 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3974 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3975
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003976 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003977 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3978 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3979 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003980 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003981
3982 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3983 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3984 defaults to 16 kB.
3985
3986 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3987 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3988
3989 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3990 Round Robin.
3991
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003992 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003993 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3994 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3995 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3996
3997 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3998
3999 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004000 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004001 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4002 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4003 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004004
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004005 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004006
4007
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004008bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4009bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004010 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4011 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4012 no | yes | yes | no
4013 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004014 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4015 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4016 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4017 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004018 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004019 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4020 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4021 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4022 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4023 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4024 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004025 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004026 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4027 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004028 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004029 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4030 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004031 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004032 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4033 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004034 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004035 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4036 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4037 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4038 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4039 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4040 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4041 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004042 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4043 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4044 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004045 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4046 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4047 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4048 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004049 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4050 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4051 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004052
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004053 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4054 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004055 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4056 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4057 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004058 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4059 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4060 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4061 the range.
4062
4063 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4064 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4065 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4066 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4067 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4068 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4069 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004070 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004071 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004072
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004073 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004074 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004075 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4076 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4077 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4078 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4079 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4080 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4081
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004082 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4083 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4084 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4085 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004087 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4088 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4089 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4090 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4091 in a frontend.
4092
4093 Example :
4094 listen http_proxy
4095 bind :80,:443
4096 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004097 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004098
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004099 listen http_https_proxy
4100 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004101 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004102
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004103 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4104 bind ipv6@:80
4105 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4106 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4107
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004108 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004109 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004110
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004111 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4112 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4113 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4114 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4115 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4116
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004117 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004118 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004119
4120
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004121bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004122 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4123 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4124 yes | yes | yes | yes
4125 Arguments :
4126 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4127 may be used to override a default value.
4128
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004129 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004130 option may be combined with other numbers.
4131
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004132 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004133 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4134 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4135 missing from all processes.
4136
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004137 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004138 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004139 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4140 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4141 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4142 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4143 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004144 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004145
4146 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4147 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4148 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4149 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4150 and 'even' instances.
4151
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004152 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4153 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4154 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4155 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004156
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004157 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4158 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4159
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004160 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4161 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4162 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4163
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004164 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4165 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4166
4167 Example :
4168 listen app_ip1
4169 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004170 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004171
4172 listen app_ip2
4173 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004174 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004175
4176 listen management
4177 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004178 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004179
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004180 listen management
4181 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4182 bind-process 1-4
4183
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004184 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004185
4186
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004187capture cookie <name> len <length>
4188 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4190 no | yes | yes | no
4191 Arguments :
4192 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4193 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4194 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4195 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004196 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004197
4198 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4199 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4200 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4201 right if it exceeds <length>.
4202
4203 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4204 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4205 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4206 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4207
4208 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4209 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4210 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4211
4212 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4213 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4214 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004215 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4216 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4217 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004218
4219 Example:
4220 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4221
4222 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004223 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004224
4225
4226capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004227 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4229 no | yes | yes | no
4230 Arguments :
4231 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004232 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004233 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4234 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4235 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4236
4237 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4238 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4239 it exceeds <length>.
4240
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004241 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004242 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4243 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004244 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4245 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4246 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4247 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004248 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004249 environments to find where the request came from.
4250
4251 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4252 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4253 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4254 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004255
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004256 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4257 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4258 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4259 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4260 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004261
4262 Example:
4263 capture request header Host len 15
4264 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004265 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004267 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004268 about logging.
4269
4270
4271capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004272 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004273 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4274 no | yes | yes | no
4275 Arguments :
4276 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004277 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004278 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4279 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4280 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4281
4282 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4283 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4284 it exceeds <length>.
4285
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004286 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004287 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4288 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4289 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004290 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4291 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4292 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4293 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004294
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004295 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4296 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4297 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4298 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4299 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004300
4301 Example:
4302 capture response header Content-length len 9
4303 capture response header Location len 15
4304
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004305 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004306 about logging.
4307
4308
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004309clitcpka-cnt <count>
4310 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4311 the connection on the client side.
4312 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4313 yes | yes | yes | no
4314 Arguments :
4315 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4316
4317 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4318 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004319 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4320 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004321
4322 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4323
4324
4325clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4326 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4327 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4328 client side.
4329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4330 yes | yes | yes | no
4331 Arguments :
4332 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4333 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4334 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4335 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4336
4337 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4338 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004339 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4340 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004341
4342 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4343
4344
4345clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4346 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4348 yes | yes | yes | no
4349 Arguments :
4350 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4351 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4352 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4353 document.
4354
4355 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4356 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004357 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4358 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004359
4360 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4361
4362
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004363compression algo <algorithm> ...
4364compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004365compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004366 Enable HTTP compression.
4367 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4368 yes | yes | yes | yes
4369 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004370 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4371 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4372 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4373
4374 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004375 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4376 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4377 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004378
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004379 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004380 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004381
4382 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4383 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4384 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4385 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4386 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004387 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004388
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004389 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4390 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4391 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4392 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4393 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4394 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4395 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004396 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004397
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004398 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004399 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004400 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4401 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4402 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4403 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4404 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004405
4406 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4407 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4408 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4409 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4410 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004411 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4412 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4413 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4414 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4415 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004416 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4417 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004418
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004419 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004420 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4421 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004422 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004423 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004424 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4425 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4426 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4427 "multipart"
4428 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4429 header
4430 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4431 and later
4432 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4433 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004434 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004435
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004436 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004437
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004438 Examples :
4439 compression algo gzip
4440 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004441
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004442
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004443cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004444 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4445 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004446 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004447 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4448 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4449 yes | no | yes | yes
4450 Arguments :
4451 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4452 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4453 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4454 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4455 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4456 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004457 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004458 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4459 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4460
4461 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4462 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4463 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4464 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4465 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4466 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004467 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4468 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004469 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004470 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4471 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004472
4473 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004474 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004475
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004476 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004477 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004478 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004479 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004480 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4481 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4482 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4483 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4484 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4485 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4486 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004487
4488 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4489 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4490 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4491 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4492 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4493 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4494 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4495 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4496 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004497 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004498 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4499 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4500 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004501
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004502 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4503 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4504 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004505 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4506 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4507 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4508 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004509 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4510 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4511 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512
4513 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4514 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4515 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4516 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4517 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4518 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4519 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4520 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4521 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4522
4523 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4524 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4525 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4526 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4527 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4528 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4529 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4530 persistence cookie in the cache.
4531 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4532
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004533 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4534 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4535 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4536 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4537 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004538 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004539 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4540 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4541 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4542 they logout.
4543
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004544 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4545 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4546 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4547 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4548
4549 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4550 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4551 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4552 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4553 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4554 this attribute.
4555
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004556 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004557 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004558 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4559 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4560 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4561 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4562 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4563 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004564
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004565 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4566 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4567 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4568 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4569 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4570 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4571 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4572 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004573 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004574 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4575 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4576 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4577 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4578 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4579 the site.
4580
4581 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4582 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4583 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4584 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4585 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4586 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4587 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4588 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4589 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4590 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4591 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4592 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4593 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004594 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004595 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4596 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4597
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004598 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4599 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4600 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4601 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4602 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4603 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4604
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004605 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4606 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4607 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4608 repeated.
4609
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004610 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4611 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4612 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4613 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004614
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004615 Examples :
4616 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4617 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4618 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004619 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004620
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004621 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004622
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004623
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004624declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4625 Declares a capture slot.
4626 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4627 no | yes | yes | no
4628 Arguments:
4629 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4630
4631 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4632 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4633 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4634 for use in the response.
4635
4636 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004637 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004638 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4639
4640
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004641default-server [param*]
4642 Change default options for a server in a backend
4643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4644 yes | no | yes | yes
4645 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004646 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4647 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4648 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4649 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004650
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004651 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004652 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4653
4654 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004655
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004656
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004657default_backend <backend>
4658 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4660 yes | yes | yes | no
4661 Arguments :
4662 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4663
4664 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4665 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4666 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4667 will catch all undetermined requests.
4668
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004669 Example :
4670
4671 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4672 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4673 default_backend dynamic
4674
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004675 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004676
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004677
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004678description <string>
4679 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4680 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4681 no | yes | yes | yes
4682 Arguments : string
4683
4684 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4685 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4686 it describes.
4687 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4688
4689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004690disabled
4691 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4693 yes | yes | yes | yes
4694 Arguments : none
4695
4696 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4697 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4698 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4699 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4700 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4701 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4702 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4703
4704 See also : "enabled"
4705
4706
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004707dispatch <address>:<port>
4708 Set a default server address
4709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4710 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004711 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004712
4713 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4714 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4715 during start-up.
4716
4717 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4718 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4719 possible with normal servers.
4720
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004721 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004722 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4723 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4724 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4725 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4726
4727 See also : "server"
4728
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004729
4730dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4731 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4732 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4733 yes | no | yes | yes
4734 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4735
4736 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004737 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004738 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4739 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004740 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004741 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004742
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004743enabled
4744 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4746 yes | yes | yes | yes
4747 Arguments : none
4748
4749 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4750 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4751
4752 See also : "disabled"
4753
4754
4755errorfile <code> <file>
4756 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4757 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4758 yes | yes | yes | yes
4759 Arguments :
4760 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004761 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004762 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004763
4764 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004765 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004766 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004767 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4768 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004769
4770 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4771 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4772 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4773
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004774 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4775
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004776 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4777 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4778 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4779 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4780 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4781 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4782 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4783 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4784 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004785
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004786 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4787 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4788 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004789 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004790 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4791
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004792 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004793
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004794 Example :
4795 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004796 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004797 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4798 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4799
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004800
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004801errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4802 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4803 section.
4804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4805 yes | yes | yes | yes
4806 Arguments :
4807 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4808
4809 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004810 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004811 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4812 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004813
4814 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4815 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4816 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4817 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4818 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004819 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004820 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4821
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004822 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4823 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004824
4825 Example :
4826 errorfiles generic
4827 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4828
4829
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004830errorloc <code> <url>
4831errorloc302 <code> <url>
4832 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4833 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4834 yes | yes | yes | yes
4835 Arguments :
4836 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004837 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004838 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004839
4840 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4841 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4842 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4843 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004844 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004845
4846 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4847 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4848 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4849
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004850 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4851
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004852 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4853 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4854 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4855 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004856 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004857 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4858 request.
4859
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004860 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004861
4862
4863errorloc303 <code> <url>
4864 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4866 yes | yes | yes | yes
4867 Arguments :
4868 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004869 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004870 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004871
4872 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4873 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4874 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4875 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004876 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004877
4878 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4879 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4880 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4881
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004882 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4883
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004884 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4885 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4886 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4887 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004888 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004889
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004890 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004891
4892
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004893email-alert from <emailaddr>
4894 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004895 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4897 yes | yes | yes | yes
4898
4899 Arguments :
4900
4901 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4902
4903 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4904 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4905
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004906 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004907 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4908 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004909
4910
4911email-alert level <level>
4912 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4913 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4914 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 yes | yes | yes | yes
4916
4917 Arguments :
4918
4919 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4920 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4921 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4922
4923 By default level is alert
4924
4925 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4926 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4927 for the proxy.
4928
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004929 Alerts are sent when :
4930
4931 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4932 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4933 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4934 is notice or lower
4935 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4936 and a health check status update occurs
4937
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004938 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4939 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004940 section 3.6 about mailers.
4941
4942
4943email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4944 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 yes | yes | yes | yes
4947
4948 Arguments :
4949
4950 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4951
4952 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4953 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4954
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004955 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4956 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004957
4958
4959email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4960 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4961 mailers.
4962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | yes | yes | yes
4964
4965 Arguments :
4966
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004967 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004968
4969 By default the systems hostname is used.
4970
4971 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4972 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4973 for the proxy.
4974
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004975 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4976 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004977
4978
4979email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004980 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004981 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4982 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4983 yes | yes | yes | yes
4984
4985 Arguments :
4986
4987 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4988
4989 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4990 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4991
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004992 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004993 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4994
4995
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004996force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4997 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4998 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004999 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005000
5001 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5002 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5003 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5004 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5005 marked down for maintenance operations.
5006
5007 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5008 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5009 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5010 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5011 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5012 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5013 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5014 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5015 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5016
5017 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5018 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5019 is used.
5020
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005021 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005022 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005023
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005024
5025filter <name> [param*]
5026 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5028 no | yes | yes | yes
5029 Arguments :
5030 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5031 referenced in section 9.
5032
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005033 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005034 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005035 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5036 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005037
5038 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5039 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5040
5041 Example:
5042 listen
5043 bind *:80
5044
5045 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5046 filter compression
5047 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5048
5049 compression algo gzip
5050 compression offload
5051
5052 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5053
5054 See also : section 9.
5055
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005056
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005057fullconn <conns>
5058 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5060 yes | no | yes | yes
5061 Arguments :
5062 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5063 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5064
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005065 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005066 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005067 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005068 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5069 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5070 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5071 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5072 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005073 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005074
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005075 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
5076 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005077 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5078 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5079 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005080
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005081 Example :
5082 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5083 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5084 # connections.
5085 backend dynamic
5086 fullconn 10000
5087 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5088 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5089
5090 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5091
5092
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005093grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005094 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005096 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005097 Arguments :
5098 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5099 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5100 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5101
5102 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5103 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005104 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005105 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5106
5107 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5108 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5109 simplify it.
5110
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005111
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005112hash-balance-factor <factor>
5113 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5115 yes | no | no | yes
5116 Arguments :
5117 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5118 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005119 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005120
5121 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5122 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5123 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5124 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5125 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5126 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5127 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5128
5129 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5130 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5131 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5132 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5133 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5134
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005135 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5136 consistent hashing mechanism.
5137
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005138 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5139
5140
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005141hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005142 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5144 yes | no | yes | yes
5145 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005146 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5147 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005148
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005149 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5150 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5151 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5152 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5153 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5154 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5155 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5156 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5157 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5158 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005159
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005160 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5161 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5162 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5163 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5164 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5165 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5166 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5167 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5168 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5169 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5170 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5171 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5172 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005173 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5174 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005175
5176 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5177
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005178 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005179 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5180 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5181 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005182 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5183 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5184 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005185
5186 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5187 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005188 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5189 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5190 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5191 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5192
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005193 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5194 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5195 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5196 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5197 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5198 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5199 parameter.
5200
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005201 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5202 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5203 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5204 used on strings.
5205
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005206 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5207
5208 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5209 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5210 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5211 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5212 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5213 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5214 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5215 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5216 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5217 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5218 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5219 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005220
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005221 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5222 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5223 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005224
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005225 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005226
5227
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005228http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5229 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5230 ones).
5231
5232 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5233 no | yes | yes | yes
5234
5235 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5236 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5237 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5238 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5239 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5240 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5241
5242 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5243 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5244 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5245
5246 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5247 below.
5248
5249 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5250 instance.
5251
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005252 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5253 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5254 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5255
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005256 Example:
5257 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5258 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5259 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5260
5261http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5262
5263 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5264 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5265 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5266 example, or to pass some internal information.
5267 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5268 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5269 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5270
5271http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5272
5273 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5274 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5275
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005276http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005277
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005278 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5279 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5280 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5281 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5282 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005283
5284http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5285 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5286
5287 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5288
5289 Example:
5290 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5291
5292 # applied to:
5293 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5294
5295 # outputs:
5296 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5297
5298 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5299
5300http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5301 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5302
5303 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5304
5305 Example:
5306 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5307
5308 # applied to:
5309 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5310
5311 # outputs:
5312 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5313
5314http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5315
5316 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5317 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5318 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5319
5320http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5321 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5322
5323 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5324 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5325 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5326 fallback.
5327
5328 Example:
5329 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5330 http-response set-status 431
5331 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5332 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5333
5334http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5335
5336 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5337 inline.
5338
5339 Arguments:
5340 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5341 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5342 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5343 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5344 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5345 (request and response)
5346 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5347 processing
5348 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5349 processing
5350 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5351 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5352 and '_'.
5353
5354 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5355 followed by some converters.
5356
5357 Example:
5358 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5359
5360http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5361
5362 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5363 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5364 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5365 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5366 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005367 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005368 processing.
5369
5370 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5371 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005372 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005373 rules evaluation.
5374
5375http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5376
5377 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5378 details about <var-name>.
5379
5380 Example:
5381 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5382
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005383
5384http-check comment <string>
5385 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5386 it fails.
5387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5388 yes | no | yes | yes
5389
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005390 Arguments :
5391 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5392 rule fails.
5393
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005394 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5395 user-friendly error reporting.
5396
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005397 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005398 "http-check expect".
5399
5400
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005401http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5402 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005403 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005404 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5406 yes | no | yes | yes
5407
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005408 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005409 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5410
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005411 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005412 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005413
5414 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5415 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5416 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5417 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5418
5419 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5420
5421 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5422
5423 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5424
5425 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5426
5427 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5428
5429 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5430 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5431 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5432 is used.
5433
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005434 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5435 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5436 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5437 haproxy -vv.
5438
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005439 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5440
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005441 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5442 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5443 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5444 different ports or with different servers.
5445
5446 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5447 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5448 the port with a "http-check connect".
5449
5450 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5451 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5452 do.
5453
5454 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5455 unset-var or comment rules.
5456
5457 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005458 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5459 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5460 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5461 option httpchk
5462
5463 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005464 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005465 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005466 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005467 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005468 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005469
5470 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5471
5472 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005473
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005474
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005475http-check disable-on-404
5476 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005478 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005479 Arguments : none
5480
5481 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5482 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5483 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5484 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5485 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5486 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5487 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5488 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005489 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5490 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005491 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5492 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5493 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005494
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005495 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005496
5497
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005498http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005499 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5500 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5501 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005502 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005504 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005505
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005506 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005507 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5508
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005509 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5510 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5511 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5512 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5513 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5514 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5515 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5516 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5517 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5518 result is always conclusive.
5519
5520 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5521 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5522 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005523 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5524 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005525 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5526 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005527 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5528 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5529 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005530
5531 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5532 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005533 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5534 supported :
5535 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5536 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005537 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5538 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5539 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5540 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5541 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005542
5543 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5544 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005545 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5546 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5547 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5548 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005549 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5550
5551 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5552 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5553 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5554 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5555
5556 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5557 informational message reported in logs if an error
5558 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5559 log-format string.
5560
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005561 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005562 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5563 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005564 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5565 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5566 details on the supported keywords.
5567
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005568 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5569 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5570 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5571 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005572
5573 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5574 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5575 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5576 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5577 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5578
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005579 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5580 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5581 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5582 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5583 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5584 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5585 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005586
5587 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005588 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005589 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5590 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5591 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5592 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5593
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005594 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5595 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005596 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5597 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5598 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5599 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5600 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5601 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5602 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5603 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005604 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5605 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5606 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5607 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5608 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5609 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5610 insensitive on the header names.
5611
5612 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5613 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5614 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5615 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5616 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5617 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005618
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005619 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005620 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005621 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5622 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5623 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5624 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5625 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005626 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005627 trace).
5628
5629 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005630 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005631 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5632 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5633 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5634 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5635 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005636 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005637
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005638 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5639 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5640 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5641 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5642 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5643 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5644
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005645 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005646 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005647 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5648 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5649 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5650 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5651 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5652 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5653
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005654 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5655 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5656 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5657 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5658 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005659
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005660 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5661 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5662
5663 Examples :
5664 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005665 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005666
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005667 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5668 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5669
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005670 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005671 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005672
5673 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005674 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005675
5676 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005677 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005678
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005679 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005680 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005681
5682
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005683http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005684 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5685 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005686 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5687 health checks.
5688 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5689 yes | no | yes | yes
5690 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005691 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5692
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005693 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5694 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5695 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5696 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5697 to invent non-standard ones.
5698
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005699 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5700 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5701 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5702 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5703
5704 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5705 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5706 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5707 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005708
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005709 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005710 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005711 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005712 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5713 to add it.
5714
5715 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5716 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5717 to the log-format rules.
5718
5719 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5720 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5721 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005722
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005723 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5724 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5725 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5726 request.
5727
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005728 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5729 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5730 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005731 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5732 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5733 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5734 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005735 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005736
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005737 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005738 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5739 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005740
5741 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5742 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5743 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5744 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5745 configured request authority.
5746
5747 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5748 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005749
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005750 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005751
5752
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005753http-check send-state
5754 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5756 yes | no | yes | yes
5757 Arguments : none
5758
5759 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5760 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5761 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5762 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5763 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5764
5765 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5766 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5767 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5768 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5769 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005770 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5771 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5772 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5773
5774 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5775 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5776 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5777
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005778 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5779 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5780 checked in multiple backends.
5781
5782 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5783 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5784
5785 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5786 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5787 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5788 one fails.
5789
5790 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5791 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5792 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5793
5794 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5795 server's queue.
5796
5797 Example of a header received by the application server :
5798 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5799 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5800
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005801 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5802 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005803
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005804
5805http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005806 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005807 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5808 yes | no | yes | yes
5809
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005810 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005811 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5812 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5813 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5814 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5815 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5816 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5817 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5818 and '-'.
5819
5820 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5821
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005822 Examples :
5823 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005824
5825
5826http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005827 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005828 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5829 yes | no | yes | yes
5830
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005831 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005832 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5833 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5834 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5835 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5836 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5837 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5838 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5839 and '-'.
5840
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005841 Examples :
5842 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005843
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005844
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005845http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5846 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5847 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5848 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5849 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5850 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5851 yes | yes | yes | yes
5852 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005853 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005854 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005855 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005856 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005857
5858 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5859 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5860 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5861 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5862
5863 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5864 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5865 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5866 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5867
5868 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5869 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5870 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5871 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5872 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5873 chroot is performed.
5874
5875 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5876 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5877 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5878 considered.
5879
5880 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5881 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5882 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5883 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5884 considered as a raw string.
5885
5886 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5887 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5888 "content-type".
5889
5890 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5891 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5892 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5893 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5894 evaluated as a log-format string.
5895
5896 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5897 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5898 argument to "content-type".
5899
5900 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5901 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5902 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5903 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5904
5905 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5906 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5907 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5908 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5909 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5910 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5911 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5912 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5913
5914 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5915 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5916 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5917
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005918 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5919 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5920 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5921 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5922 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5923
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005924 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5925 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5926
5927
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005928http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005929 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5930
5931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5932 no | yes | yes | yes
5933
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005934 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5935 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5936 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5937 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5938 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005939
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005940 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5941 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005943 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005945 Example:
5946 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5947 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5948 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005949
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005950 http-request allow if nagios
5951 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5952 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5953 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005954
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005955 Example:
5956 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5957 acl add path /addacl
5958 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005959
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005960 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005961
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005962 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5963 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005964
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005965 Example:
5966 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5967 acl setmap path /setmap
5968 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005969
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005970 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005971
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005972 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5973 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005974
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005975 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5976 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005977
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005978http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005979
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005980 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5981 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5982 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5983 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5984 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5985 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5986 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5987 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005989http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005990
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005991 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5992 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5993 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5994 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5995 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5996 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5997 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5998 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005999
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006000http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006001
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006002 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6003 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006004
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006005
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006006http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006007
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006008 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6009 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6010 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6011 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6012 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006013
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006014 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6015 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6016 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6017 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6018 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6019 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6020 instead.
6021
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006022 Example:
6023 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6024 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006025
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006026http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006027
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006028 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006029
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006030http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6031 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006032
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006033 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6034 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6035 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6036 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6037 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6038 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6039 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6040 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6041 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006042
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006043 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6044 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6045 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006046 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6047
6048 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6049 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6050 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6051 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006052
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006053http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6056 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6057 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6058 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6059 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6060 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006061
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006062http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006063
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006064 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6065 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6066 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6067 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6068 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006069
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006070http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006071
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006072 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6073 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6074 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6075 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6076 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6077 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006078
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006079http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6080http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6081 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6082 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6083 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6084 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006085
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006086 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6087 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6088 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006089 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006090 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6091 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6092 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006093 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006094 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006095
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006096http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6097 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6098 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6099 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6100
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006101http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6102
6103 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6104 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6105 pointed by <resolvers>.
6106 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6107 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6108 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6109 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6110 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6111 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6112 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6113 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6114 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6115 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6116 to 0.0.0.0.
6117
6118 Example:
6119 resolvers mydns
6120 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6121 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6122 timeout retry 1s
6123 hold valid 10s
6124 hold nx 3s
6125 hold other 3s
6126 hold obsolete 0s
6127 accepted_payload_size 8192
6128
6129 frontend fe
6130 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6131 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6132 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6133
6134 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6135 # which mean DNS resolution error
6136 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6137
6138 default_backend be
6139
6140 backend b_503
6141 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6142 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6143 # 503 error page to end users
6144
6145 backend be
6146 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6147 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6148 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6149 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6150 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6151
6152 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6153 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6154
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006155http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6156
6157 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6158 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6159 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6160 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006161 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6162 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006163
6164 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6165
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006166http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006167http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006168http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006169http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006170http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006171http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6172http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006173
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006174 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6175
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006176 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
6177 technical preview. You should be prepared that the behavior of normalizers
6178 might change to fix possible issues, possibly breaking proper request
6179 processing in your infrastructure.
6180
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006181 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6182 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6183 the supported backend.
6184
6185 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6186 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6187 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6188 number of segments in the path.
6189
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006190 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6191 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6192 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6193 when improperly combined.
6194
6195 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6196 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6197 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6198 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6199 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6200
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006201 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006202
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006203 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6204 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006205
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006206 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6207 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6208
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006209 Example:
6210 - /. -> /
6211 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6212 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6213 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006214
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006215 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6216 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6217
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006218 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006219 their preceding segment.
6220
6221 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6222 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6223
6224 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6225 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006226
6227 Example:
6228 - /foo/../ -> /
6229 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6230 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6231 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006232 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006233 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006234 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006235
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006236 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6237 removed as well:
6238
6239 Example:
6240 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6241 - /bar/../../ -> /
6242
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006243 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6244 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006245
6246 Example:
6247 - // -> /
6248 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6249
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006250 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6251 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6252
6253 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6254 ".", "_", and "~".
6255
6256 Example:
6257 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6258 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6259 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6260 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6261
6262 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6263 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6264
6265 Example:
6266 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6267 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6268
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006269 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006270 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006271
6272 Example:
6273 - /%6f -> /%6F
6274 - /%zz -> /%zz
6275
6276 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6277 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6278
6279 Example:
6280 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6281
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006282 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006283 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6284 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6285
6286 Example:
6287 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6288 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6289 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6290
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006291http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006292
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006293 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6294 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6295 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6296 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6297 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006298
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006299http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006300
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006301 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6302 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6303 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6304 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006305
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006306http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6307 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006308
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006309 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006310 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6311 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6312 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6313 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6314 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006315
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006316 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6317 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6318 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6319 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6320 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006321
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006322 Example:
6323 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6324
6325 # applied to:
6326 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6327
6328 # outputs:
6329 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6330
6331 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006332
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006333 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6334
6335 # applied to:
6336 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006337
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006338 # outputs:
6339 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006340
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006341http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6342 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6343
6344 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6345 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006346 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6347 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6348 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006349
6350 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6351 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6352 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6353
6354 Example:
6355 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6356 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6357
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006358 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6359 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6360 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6361 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6362
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006363http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6364 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6365
6366 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6367 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6368 query-string are replaced.
6369
6370 Example:
6371 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6372 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6373
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006374http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6375 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6376
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006377 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6378 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6379 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6380 against.
6381
6382 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6383 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6384 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006385
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006386 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6387 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6388 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6389 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6390 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6391 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6392 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6393 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6394 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006395 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6396 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006397
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006398 Example:
6399 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6400 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006401
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006402 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6403 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006404
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006405http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6406 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006407
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006408 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6409 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6410 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6411 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006412
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006413 Example:
6414 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006415
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006416 # applied to:
6417 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006418
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006419 # outputs:
6420 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006421
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006422http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6423 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6424 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006425 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006426 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6427
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006428 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006429 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6430 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006431 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006432 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006433 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006434 are followed to create the response :
6435
6436 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6437 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6438 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6439 ignored.
6440
6441 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6442 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006443 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006444 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6445 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006446
6447 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6448 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6449 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006450 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6451 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006452
6453 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6454 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6455 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006456 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006457 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006458 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006459
6460 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6461 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6462 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6463 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6464 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6465 as a raw content.
6466
6467 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6468 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6469 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6470 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6471 considered as a raw string.
6472
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006473 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006474 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6475 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6476 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6477
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006478 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6479 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006480 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006481
6482 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6483
6484 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006485 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006486 if { path /ping }
6487
6488 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6489 if { path /favicon.ico }
6490
6491 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6492 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6493 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6494
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006495http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6496http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006497
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006498 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6499 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6500 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006501
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006502http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6503 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006504
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006505 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6506 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6507 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6508 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006509
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006510http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006511
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006512 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6513 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6514 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6515 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6516 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006517
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006518 Arguments:
6519 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6520 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006521
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006522 Example:
6523 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6524 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006526 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6527 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006528
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006529http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006530
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006531 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6532 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6533 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006534
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006535 Arguments:
6536 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6537 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006538
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006539 Example:
6540 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6541 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006542
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006543 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6544 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6545 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006546
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006547http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006548
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006549 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6550 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6551 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6552 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6553 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006554
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006555 Example:
6556 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6557 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6558 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6559 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6560 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6561 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6562 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6563 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6564 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006565
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006566http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006567
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006568 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6569 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6570 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6571 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6572 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006573
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006574http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6575 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006576
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006577 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6578 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6579 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6580 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6581 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6582 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6583 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6584 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6585 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006586
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006587http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006588
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006589 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6590 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6591 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6592 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6593 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6594 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6595 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006596
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006597http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006598
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006599 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6600 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6601 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006603http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006604
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006605 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6606 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6607 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6608 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6609 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6610 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6611 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6612 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006613
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006614http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006615
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006616 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6617 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6618 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6619 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6620 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6621 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006622
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006623 Example :
6624 # prepend the host name before the path
6625 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006626
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006627http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6628
6629 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6630 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6631 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6632
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006633http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006634
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006635 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6636 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6637 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6638 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6639 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006640
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006641http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006642
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006643 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6644 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6645 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6646 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6647 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6648 values have higher priority.
6649 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6650 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6651 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6652 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6653 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006654
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006655http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006656
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006657 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6658 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6659 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6660 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6661 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6662 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6663 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006664
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006665 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006666
6667 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006668 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6669 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006671http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6672 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6673 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6674 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006675 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6676 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006677
6678 Arguments :
6679 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6680 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006681
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006682 See also "option forwardfor".
6683
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006684 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006685 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6686 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6687
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006688 # After the masking this will track connections
6689 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6690 http-request track-sc0 src
6691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006692 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6693 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6694
6695http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6696
6697 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6698 expression.
6699
6700 Arguments:
6701 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6702 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006703
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006704 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006705 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6706 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6707
6708 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6709 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6710 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6711
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006712http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006713 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6714
6715 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6716 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6717 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6718 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6719 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6720
6721 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6722 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6723 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6724 results.
6725
6726 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006727 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6728 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006730http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6731
6732 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6733 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6734 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6735 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6736 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6737 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6738 information from the request.
6739
6740 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6741
6742http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6743
6744 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6745 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6746 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6747 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6748 path and the query string.
6749 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6750
6751http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6752
6753 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6754 inline.
6755
6756 Arguments:
6757 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6758 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6759 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6760 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6761 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6762 (request and response)
6763 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6764 processing
6765 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6766 processing
6767 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6768 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6769 and '_'.
6770
6771 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6772 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006773
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006774 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006775 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006776
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006777http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6778 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006779
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006780 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6781 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6782 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6783 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6784 agent name must be used.
6785
6786 Arguments:
6787 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6788
6789 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6790 configuration.
6791
6792http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6793
6794 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6795 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6796 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6797 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6798 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6799 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6800 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6801 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6802 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6803 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6804 action.
6805 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6806 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6807 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6808 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6809 you fully understand how it works.
6810
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006811http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6812
6813 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6814 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6815 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6816 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6817 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006818 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006819 processing.
6820
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006821 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006822 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6823 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6824 rules evaluation.
6825
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006826http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6827http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6828 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6829 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6830 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6831 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006832
6833 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6834 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6835 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006836 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6837 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6838 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6839 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6840 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6841 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6842 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6843 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6844 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6845 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006846 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006847 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6848 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6849 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6850 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6851 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006852
6853http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6854http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6855http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6856
6857 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6858 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6859 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6860 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006861 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006862 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6863 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6864 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6865 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6866 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6867 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6868 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6869
6870 Arguments :
6871 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6872 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6873 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6874 select which table entry to update the counters.
6875
6876 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6877 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6878 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6879 that table until the session ends.
6880
6881 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6882 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6883 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6884 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6885 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6886 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6887 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6888 useful information.
6889
6890 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6891 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6892 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6893 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6894 checks that make use of it.
6895
6896http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6897
6898 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006899
6900 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006901 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006902
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006903http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6904
6905 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6906 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6907 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6908 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6909 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6910 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6911
6912 Arguments :
6913 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6914
6915 Example:
6916 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6917
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006918http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6919 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6920
6921 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6922 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6923 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6924 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6925 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6926 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6927 http-buffer-request".
6928
6929 Arguments :
6930
6931 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6932 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6933
6934 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05006935 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006936 bytes.
6937
6938 Example:
6939 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6940
6941 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6942
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006943http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006944
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006945 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6946 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6947 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006948
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006949
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006950http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006951 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6952
6953 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6954 no | yes | yes | yes
6955
6956 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6957 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6958 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6959 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6960 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6961 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6962
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006963 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6964 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006965
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006966 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006967
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006968 Example:
6969 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006970
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006971 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006972
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006973 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6974 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006976 Example:
6977 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006978
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006979 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006980
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006981 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6982 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006983
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006984 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6985 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006986
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006987http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006988
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006989 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6990 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6991 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6992 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6993 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6994 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6995 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6996 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006997
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006998http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006999
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007000 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7001 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7002 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7003 example, or to pass some internal information.
7004 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7005 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7006 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007007
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007008http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007010 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7011 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007012
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007013http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007014
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007015 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007016
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007017http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007018
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007019 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7020 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7021 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7022 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7023 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7024 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7025 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007026
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007027 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7028 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7029 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7030 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7031 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007032
7033 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7034 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7035 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7036 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007038http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007040 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7041 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7042 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7043 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7044 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7045 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007046
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007047http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007048
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007049 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7050 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7051 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7052 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7053 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007054
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007055http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007056
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007057 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7058 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7059 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7060 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7061 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7062 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007063
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007064http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7065http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7066 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7067 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7068 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7069 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007070
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007071 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7072 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7073 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007074 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007075 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7076 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7077 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007078 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007079 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007080
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007081http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007082
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007083 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7084 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7085 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7086 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7087 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7088 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007089
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007090http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7091 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007092
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007093 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7094 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007095
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007096 Example:
7097 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007099 # applied to:
7100 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007101
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007102 # outputs:
7103 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007104
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007105 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007107http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7108 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007109
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007110 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007111 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007112
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007113 Example:
7114 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007115
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007116 # applied to:
7117 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007118
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007119 # outputs:
7120 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007121
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007122http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7123 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7124 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007125 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007126 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7127
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007128 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007129 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7130 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007131 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007132 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007133 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007134 are followed to create the response :
7135
7136 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7137 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7138 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7139 ignored.
7140
7141 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7142 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007143 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007144 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7145 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007146
7147 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7148 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7149 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007150 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
7151 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007152
7153 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7154 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7155 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007156 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007157 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007158 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007159
7160 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7161 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7162 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7163 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7164 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7165 as a raw content.
7166
7167 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7168 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7169 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7170 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7171 considered as a raw string.
7172
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007173 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7174 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7175 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7176 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7177
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007178 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7179 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007180 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007181
7182 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7183
7184 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007185 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007186 if { status eq 404 }
7187
7188 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7189 string "This is the end !" \
7190 if { status eq 500 }
7191
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007192http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7193http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007195 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7196 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7197 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007198
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007199http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7200 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007201
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007202 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7203 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7204 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7205 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007206
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007207http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007209 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7210 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7211 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7212 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7213 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007214
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007215 Arguments:
7216 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007217
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007218 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7219 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007220
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007221http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007222
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007223 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7224 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7225 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007226
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007227http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7228
7229 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7230 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7231 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7232 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7233 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7234
7235http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7236
7237 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7238 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7239 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7240 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7241 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7242 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7243 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7244 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7245 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7246
7247http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7248
7249 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7250 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7251 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7252 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7253 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7254 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7255 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7256
7257http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7258
7259 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7260 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7261 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7262 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7263 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7264 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7265 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7266 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7267
7268http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7269 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7270
7271 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7272 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7273 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7274 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007275
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007276 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007277 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7278 http-response set-status 431
7279 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7280 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007281
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007282http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007283
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007284 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7285 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7286 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7287 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7288 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7289 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7290 based on some information from the request.
7291
7292 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7293
7294http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7295
7296 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7297 inline.
7298
7299 Arguments:
7300 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7301 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7302 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7303 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7304 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7305 (request and response)
7306 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7307 processing
7308 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7309 processing
7310 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7311 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7312 and '_'.
7313
7314 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7315 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007316
7317 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007318 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007319
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007320http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007322 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7323 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7324 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7325 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7326 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7327 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7328 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7329 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7330 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7331 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7332 action.
7333 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7334 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7335 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7336 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7337 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007338
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007339http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7340
7341 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7342 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7343 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7344 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7345 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007346 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007347 processing.
7348
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007349 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007350 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007351 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007352 rules evaluation.
7353
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007354http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7355http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7356http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007357
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007358 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7359 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7360 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7361 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7362 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7363 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7364
7365http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7366
7367 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7368 about <var-name>.
7369
7370 Example:
7371 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7372
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007373http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7374 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7375
7376 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7377 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7378 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7379 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7380 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7381 buffer is full.
7382
7383 Arguments :
7384
7385 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7386 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7387
7388 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007389 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007390 bytes.
7391
7392 Example:
7393 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007394
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007395http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7396 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7397
7398 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7399 yes | no | yes | yes
7400
7401 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007402 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7403 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7404 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007405
7406 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7407
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007408 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7409 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7410 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7411 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7412 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7413 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7414 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7415 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7416 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7417 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007418
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007419 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7420 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7421 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7422 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7423 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7424 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7425 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007426 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7427 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7428 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7429 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7430 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7431 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007432
7433 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7434 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7435 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7436 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7437 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7438 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7439 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7440 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007441 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007442 downsides of rare connection failures.
7443
7444 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7445 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7446 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7447 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7448 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7449 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007450 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007451 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7452 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7453 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7454 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7455 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7456
7457 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007458 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7459 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7460 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7461 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007462
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007463 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7464 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007465
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007466 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007467
7468 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7469 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7470 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7471
7472 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7473
7474
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007475http-send-name-header [<header>]
7476 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007477 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7478 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007479 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007480 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7481
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007482 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7483 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7484 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7485 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7486 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7487 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7488 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7489 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7490 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7491 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7492 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7493 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7494 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7495 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7496 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7497 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007498
7499 See also : "server"
7500
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007501id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007502 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7504 no | yes | yes | yes
7505 Arguments : none
7506
7507 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7508 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7509 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007510
7511
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007512ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7513 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7514 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007515 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007516
7517 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7518 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7519 and running).
7520
7521 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7522 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7523 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007524 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007525 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7526
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007527 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7528 "unless" condition is met.
7529
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007530 Example:
7531 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7532 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7533 ignore-persist if url_static
7534
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007535 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7536
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007537load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7538 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7539 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7540 yes | no | yes | yes
7541
7542 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7543 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7544 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007545 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007546 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7547 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7548 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7549 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7550
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007551 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007552 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007553 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007554
7555 Arguments:
7556 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7557 named "server-state-file".
7558
7559 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7560 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7561 name is used as a file name.
7562
7563 none don't load any stat for this backend
7564
7565 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007566 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7567 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7568 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007569 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007570 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007571
7572 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7573 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7574
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007575 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007576
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007577 global
7578 stats socket /tmp/socket
7579 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007580
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007581 defaults
7582 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007583
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007584 backend bk
7585 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7586 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007587
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007588
7589 Then one can run :
7590
7591 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7592
7593 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7594
7595 1
7596 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7597 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7598 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7599
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007600 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007601
7602 global
7603 stats socket /tmp/socket
7604 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7605
7606 defaults
7607 load-server-state-from-file local
7608
7609 backend bk
7610 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7611 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7612
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007613
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007614 Then one can run :
7615
7616 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7617
7618 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7619
7620 1
7621 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7622 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7623 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7624
7625 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7626 "show servers state"
7627
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007628
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007629log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007630log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007631 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007632no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007633 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7634 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7635 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007636
7637 Prefix :
7638 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7639 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7640 prefix does not allow arguments.
7641
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007642 Arguments :
7643 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7644 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7645 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7646 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7647 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7648 parameter.
7649
7650 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7651 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7652
7653 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7654 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7655 standard syslog port).
7656
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007657 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7658 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7659 standard syslog port).
7660
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007661 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7662 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7663 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007664 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007665
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007666 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7667 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7668 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7669 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7670 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7671 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7672 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7673 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7674 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7675 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7676 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7677 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7678 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7679 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7680 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7681 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007682 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7683 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007684
7685 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7686 and "fd@2", see above.
7687
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007688 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7689 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7690 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7691 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7692 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7693 having the logs instantly available.
7694
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007695 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7696 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7697 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7698
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007699 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7700 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007701
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007702 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7703 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7704 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7705 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7706 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7707 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7708 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7709 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7710 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7711 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007712 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007713
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007714 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7715 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7716 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7717 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7718 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7719
7720 <sample_size>
7721 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7722 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7723 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7724 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7725 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7726
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007727 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7728 one of the following :
7729
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007730 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7731 field is stripped. This is the default.
7732 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7733 rfc3164.
7734
7735 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007736 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7737
7738 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7739 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7740
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007741 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7742 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7743 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7744 designed to be used with a local log server.
7745
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007746 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7747 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7748 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7749 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7750 systemd logger consumes.
7751
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007752 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7753 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7754 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7755 used with a local log server.
7756
7757 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7758 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7759 designed to be used with a local log server.
7760
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007761 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7762 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7763 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7764 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7765
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007766 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7767
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007768 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7769 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7770 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7771
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007772 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7773 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7774 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7775 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007776
7777 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7778 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7779 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007780 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7781 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7782 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7783 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7784 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007785
7786 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7787
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007788 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7789 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7790 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007791
7792 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7793 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7794 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7795 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7796
7797 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7798 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007799
7800 Example :
7801 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007802 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7803 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7804 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007805 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007806 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7807 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007808 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007809
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007810
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007811log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007812 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7813 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7814 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007815
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007816 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7817 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7818 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7819 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7820 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007821
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007822 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7823 "option httplog" directives.
7824
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007825log-format-sd <string>
7826 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7827 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7828 yes | yes | yes | no
7829
7830 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7831 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7832 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7833 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7834 which covers the log format string in depth.
7835
7836 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7837 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7838
7839 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7840 log format to "rfc5424".
7841
7842 Example :
7843 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7844
7845
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007846log-tag <string>
7847 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7848 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7849 yes | yes | yes | yes
7850
7851 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7852 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7853 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7854 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7855 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7856 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7857 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7858 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7859 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007860
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007861max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7862 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7863 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7864 yes | no | yes | yes
7865
7866 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7867 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7868 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7869 servers.
7870
7871 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7872 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7873 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7874 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7875 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007876 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007877 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7878 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7879 picking a different server.
7880
7881 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7882 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7883 even if they have to be queued.
7884
7885 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7886 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7887
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007888max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7889 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7890 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7891 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007892
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007893maxconn <conns>
7894 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7896 yes | yes | yes | no
7897 Arguments :
7898 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7899 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7900 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7901 closes.
7902
7903 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7904 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7905 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7906 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007907 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7908 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7909 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7910 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007911
7912 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7913 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7914 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7915
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007916 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7917 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007918
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007919 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7920
7921
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007922mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007923 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7924 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7925 yes | yes | yes | yes
7926 Arguments :
7927 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7928 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7929 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7930 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7931
7932 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7933 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7934 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7935 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7936 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7937
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007938 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7939 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7940 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007941
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007942 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007943 defaults http_instances
7944 mode http
7945
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007946
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007947monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007948 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7950 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007951 Arguments :
7952 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7953 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007954 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007955 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7956 backend and its backup.
7957
7958 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7959 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7960 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7961 servers in a list of backends.
7962
7963 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7964 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7965 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7966 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7967 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7968 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7969 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007970 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7971 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007972
7973 Example:
7974 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007975 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007976 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7977 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7978 monitor-uri /site_alive
7979 monitor fail if site_dead
7980
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007981 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007982
7983
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007984monitor-uri <uri>
7985 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7986 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7987 yes | yes | yes | no
7988 Arguments :
7989 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7990 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7991
7992 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7993 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7994 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7995 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7996 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7997 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7998 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7999 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8000
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008001 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008002 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8003 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8004 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8005 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8006 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8007 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008008
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008009 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8010 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8011 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8012 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8013
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008014 Example :
8015 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
8016 frontend www
8017 mode http
8018 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8019
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008020 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008021
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008022
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008023option abortonclose
8024no option abortonclose
8025 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8026 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8027 yes | no | yes | yes
8028 Arguments : none
8029
8030 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8031 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8032 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8033 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008034 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008035 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8036 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8037 encountered while delivering the response.
8038
8039 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8040 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8041 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8042 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8043 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8044 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008045 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008046 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008047 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008048 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8049 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8050 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8051
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008052 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8053 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008054 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8055 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8056 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8057 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8058 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8059 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008060 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008061
8062 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8063 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8064
8065 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8066
8067
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008068option accept-invalid-http-request
8069no option accept-invalid-http-request
8070 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8071 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8072 yes | yes | yes | no
8073 Arguments : none
8074
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008075 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008076 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008077 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008078 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8079 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8080 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8081 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8082 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008083 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8084 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8085 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8086 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008087 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008088 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008089 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8090 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8091 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008092
8093 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8094 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8095 been confirmed.
8096
8097 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8098 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008099 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8100 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008101 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8102
8103 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8104 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8105
8106 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8107 stats socket.
8108
8109
8110option accept-invalid-http-response
8111no option accept-invalid-http-response
8112 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8113 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8114 yes | no | yes | yes
8115 Arguments : none
8116
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008117 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008118 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008119 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008120 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8121 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8122 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8123 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8124 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008125 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8126 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8127 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008128
8129 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8130 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8131 been confirmed.
8132
8133 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8134 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8135 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8136 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8137
8138 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8139 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8140
8141 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8142 stats socket.
8143
8144
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008145option allbackups
8146no option allbackups
8147 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8148 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8149 yes | no | yes | yes
8150 Arguments : none
8151
8152 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8153 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8154 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8155 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8156 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8157 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8158 order between the backup servers anymore.
8159
8160 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8161 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8162
8163 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8164 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8165
8166
8167option checkcache
8168no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008169 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8171 yes | no | yes | yes
8172 Arguments : none
8173
8174 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8175 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008176 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008177 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8178 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008179 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008180
8181 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008182 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008183 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008184 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8185 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008186 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008187 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008188 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8189 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008190 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008191 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8192 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008193 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008194 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8195 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8196 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8197 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8198 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8199 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8200 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8201 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8202 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8203
8204 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008205 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8206 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8207 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8208 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008209
8210 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8211 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008212 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008213 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008214
8215 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8216 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8217
8218
8219option clitcpka
8220no option clitcpka
8221 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8222 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8223 yes | yes | yes | no
8224 Arguments : none
8225
8226 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8227 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008228 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008229 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8230
8231 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8232 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8233 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8234 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8235
8236 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8237 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8238 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8239 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8240 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8241
8242 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8243
8244 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8245 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8246 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8247
8248 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8249 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8250
8251 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8252
8253
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008254option contstats
8255 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8257 yes | yes | yes | no
8258 Arguments : none
8259
8260 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8261 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8262 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8263 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008264 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8265 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8266 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8267 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8268 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008269
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008270option disable-h2-upgrade
8271no option disable-h2-upgrade
8272 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8273 connection.
8274 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8275 yes | yes | yes | no
8276 Arguments : none
8277
8278 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8279 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8280 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8281 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008282 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8283 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8284 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8285 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8286 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8287 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008288
8289 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8290 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008291
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008292option dontlog-normal
8293no option dontlog-normal
8294 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8296 yes | yes | yes | no
8297 Arguments : none
8298
8299 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8300 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8301 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8302 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8303 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8304 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8305 logged.
8306
8307 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8308 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8309 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8310
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008311 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008312 logging.
8313
8314
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008315option dontlognull
8316no option dontlognull
8317 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8318 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8319 yes | yes | yes | no
8320 Arguments : none
8321
8322 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8323 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8324 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8325 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8326 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8327 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008328 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8329 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8330 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008331
8332 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008333 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008334 would not be logged.
8335
8336 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8337 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8338
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008339 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008340 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008341
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008342
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008343option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008344 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8345 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8346 yes | yes | yes | yes
8347 Arguments :
8348 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8349 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008350 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008351 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008352
8353 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8354 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8355 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8356 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8357 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8358 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8359 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008360 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8361 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8362 possible that the client has already brought one.
8363
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008364 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008365 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008366 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008367 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008368 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008369 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008370
8371 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8372 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8373 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8374 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8375 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8376 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008377 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008378
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008379 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8380 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8381 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8382 are under the control of the end-user.
8383
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008384 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008385 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8386 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008387 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8388 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8389 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008390
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008391 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008392 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8393 frontend www
8394 mode http
8395 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8396
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008397 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8398 backend www
8399 mode http
8400 option forwardfor header X-Client
8401
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008402 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008403 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008404
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008405
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008406option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8407no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8408 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8409 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8410 yes | yes | yes | no
8411 Arguments : none
8412
8413 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8414 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8415 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8416 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8417 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8418 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8419 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8420
8421 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8422 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8423 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8424 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8425 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8426 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8427 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8428 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8429 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8430 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8431
8432 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8433
8434 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8435 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8436
8437 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8438 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8439
8440
8441option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8442no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8443 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8445 yes | no | yes | yes
8446 Arguments : none
8447
8448 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8449 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8450 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8451 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8452 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8453 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8454 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8455
8456 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8457 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8458 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8459 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8460 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8461 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8462 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8463 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8464 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8465 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8466
8467 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8468
8469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8471
8472 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8473 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8474
8475
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008476option http-buffer-request
8477no option http-buffer-request
8478 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8480 yes | yes | yes | yes
8481 Arguments : none
8482
8483 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8484 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8485 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8486 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8487 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8488 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008489 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8490 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8491 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8492 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008493
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008494 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8495 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008496
8497
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008498option http-ignore-probes
8499no option http-ignore-probes
8500 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8502 yes | yes | yes | no
8503 Arguments : none
8504
8505 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8506 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8507 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8508 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8509 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8510 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8511 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8512 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8513 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008514 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8515 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008516 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8517
8518 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8519 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8520 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8521 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8522 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8523 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8524 are often the only way to detect them.
8525
8526 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8527 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8528
8529 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8530
8531
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008532option http-keep-alive
8533no option http-keep-alive
8534 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8536 yes | yes | yes | yes
8537 Arguments : none
8538
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008539 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8540 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008541 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8542 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008543 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8544 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8545 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008546
8547 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8548 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008549 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8550 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8551 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8552 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8553 situations where this option may be useful :
8554
8555 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008556 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008557
8558 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8559 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8560
8561 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8562 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8563 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8564 request.
8565
8566 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8567 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008568 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8569 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8570 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008571
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008572 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8573 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8574 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8575 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8576 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8577 not set.
8578
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008579 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8580 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8581 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008582
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008583 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008584 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008585 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008586
8587
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008588option http-no-delay
8589no option http-no-delay
8590 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8591 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8592 yes | yes | yes | yes
8593 Arguments : none
8594
8595 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8596 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8597 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8598 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8599 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8600 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8601 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8602 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8603 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8604 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8605 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8606 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8607 affected.
8608
8609 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8610 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8611 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8612 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8613 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8614 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8615 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8616 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8617 latency environments.
8618
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008619 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8620
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008621
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008622option http-pretend-keepalive
8623no option http-pretend-keepalive
8624 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8625 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008626 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008627 Arguments : none
8628
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008629 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008630 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8631 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8632 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8633 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8634 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8635 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8636 consider the response complete.
8637
8638 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8639 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8640 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8641 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008642 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008643 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8644
8645 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8646 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8647 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8648 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8649 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8650 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8651 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8652
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008653 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8654 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8655 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8656 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8657 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8658 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008659
8660 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8661 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8662
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008663 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008664 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008665
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008666
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008667option http-server-close
8668no option http-server-close
8669 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8670 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8671 yes | yes | yes | yes
8672 Arguments : none
8673
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008674 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8675 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8676 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8677 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008678 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8679 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8680 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8681 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8682 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8683 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8684 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8685 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8686 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8687 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8688 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008689
8690 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8691 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8692 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8693 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008694 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8695 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008696
8697 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8698 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008699 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8700 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8701 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008702
8703 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8704 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8705
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008706 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8707 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008708
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008709option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008710no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008711 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8712 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8713 yes | yes | yes | no
8714 Arguments : none
8715
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008716 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008717 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8718 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8719 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8720 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8721 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8722 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8723
8724 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8725 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008726 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8727 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8728 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008729
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008730 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8731 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8732 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8733 front of an existing proxy.
8734
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008735 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8736
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008737 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008738
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008739option httpchk
8740option httpchk <uri>
8741option httpchk <method> <uri>
8742option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008743 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008744 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8745 yes | no | yes | yes
8746 Arguments :
8747 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8748 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8749 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8750 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8751 ones.
8752
8753 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8754 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8755 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8756
8757 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8758 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8759 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008760 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008761
8762 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8763 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8764 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8765 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8766 the lack of any response.
8767
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008768 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8769 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8770 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8771 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8772
8773 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8774 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8775 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008776
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008777 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8778 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008779 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008780 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008781 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008782
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008783 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8784 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8785 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8786 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8787
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008788 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008789 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8790 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8791 backend https_relay
8792 mode tcp
8793 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8794 http-check send hdr Host www
8795 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008796
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008797 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8798 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8799 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008800
8801
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008802option httpclose
8803no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008804 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008805 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8806 yes | yes | yes | yes
8807 Arguments : none
8808
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008809 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8810 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8811 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8812 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008813 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008814
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008815 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8816 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008817 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008818 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8819 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008820
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008821 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8822 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8823 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008824
8825 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8826 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008827 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8828 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8829 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008830
8831 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8832 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8833
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008834 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008835
8836
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008837option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008838 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008840 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008841 Arguments :
8842 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8843 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8844 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008845 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008846 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008847
8848 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8849 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8850 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8851 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8852 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8853 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8854 ports.
8855
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008856 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8857 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008858
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008859 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8860
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008861 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008862
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008863
8864option http_proxy
8865no option http_proxy
8866 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8868 yes | yes | yes | yes
8869 Arguments : none
8870
8871 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8872 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8873 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8874 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8875 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8876
8877 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8878 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008879 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8880 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008881
8882 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8883 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8884
8885 Example :
8886 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8887 backend direct_forward
8888 option httpclose
8889 option http_proxy
8890
8891 See also : "option httpclose"
8892
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008893
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008894option independent-streams
8895no option independent-streams
8896 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8898 yes | yes | yes | yes
8899 Arguments : none
8900
8901 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8902 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8903 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8904 receive data or not.
8905
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008906 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008907 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8908 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8909 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8910 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8911 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8912 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8913 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8914 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8915 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8916 socket buffers.
8917
8918 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8919 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8920 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8921 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8922 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8923
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008924 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008925
8926
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008927option ldap-check
8928 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8929 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8930 yes | no | yes | yes
8931 Arguments : none
8932
8933 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8934 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8935 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8936 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8937
8938 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8939 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8940
8941 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8942 configure it.
8943
8944 Example :
8945 option ldap-check
8946
8947 See also : "option httpchk"
8948
8949
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008950option external-check
8951 Use external processes for server health checks
8952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8953 yes | no | yes | yes
8954
8955 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8956 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8957 command".
8958
8959 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8960
8961 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8962
8963
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008964option log-health-checks
8965no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008966 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8968 yes | no | yes | yes
8969 Arguments : none
8970
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008971 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8972 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8973 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008974
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008975 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8976 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8977 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8978 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8979 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8980
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008981 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008982 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008983
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008984 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8985 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8986 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008987
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008988
8989option log-separate-errors
8990no option log-separate-errors
8991 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8993 yes | yes | yes | no
8994 Arguments : none
8995
8996 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8997 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8998 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8999 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9000 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9001 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9002 provides very important information.
9003
9004 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9005 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9006 error logs.
9007
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009008 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009009 logging.
9010
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009011
9012option logasap
9013no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009014 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9016 yes | yes | yes | no
9017 Arguments : none
9018
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009019 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9020 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9021 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9022 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9023
9024 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9025 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9026 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9027 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9028 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009029 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009030 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9031 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9032 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9033 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009034 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009035
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009036 Examples :
9037 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9038 mode http
9039 option httplog
9040 option logasap
9041 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9042
9043 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9044 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9045 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9046 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009048 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009049 logging.
9050
9051
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009052option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009053 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9055 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009056 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009057 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9058 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009059 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9060 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009061
9062 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9063 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009064 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009065 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
9066 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
9067 in the MySQL table, like this :
9068
9069 USE mysql;
9070 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
9071 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
9072
9073 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009074 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009075 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9076 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9077 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9078 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9079 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9080 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9081 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9082
9083 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9084 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009085
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009086 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009087
9088 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9089 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9090 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9091 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009092 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
9093 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009094
9095 See also: "option httpchk"
9096
9097
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009098option nolinger
9099no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009100 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009101 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9102 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009103 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009104
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009105 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009106 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9107 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9108 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9109 connections.
9110
9111 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9112 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009113 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9114 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9115 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9116 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9117 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9118 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9119 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9120 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9121 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9122 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9123 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9124 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9125 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009126
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009127 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9128 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9129 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9130 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9131 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009132
9133 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9134 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009135 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009136 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009137 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009138
9139 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9140 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9141
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009142 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9143 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009144
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009145option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9146 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9147 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9148 yes | yes | yes | yes
9149 Arguments :
9150 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9151 matching <network>
9152 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9153 header name.
9154
9155 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9156 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9157 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9158 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9159 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9160 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9161 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9162 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9163 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9164 possible that the client has already brought one.
9165
9166 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9167 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9168 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9169 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9170 header and requires different one.
9171
9172 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9173 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9174 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009175 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9176 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9177 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9178 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9179 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009180
9181 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9182 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9183 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9184 both are defined.
9185
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009186 Examples :
9187 # Original Destination address
9188 frontend www
9189 mode http
9190 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9191
9192 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9193 backend www
9194 mode http
9195 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9196
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009197 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009198
9199
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009200option persist
9201no option persist
9202 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9203 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9204 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009205 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009206
9207 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9208 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9209 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9210 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9211 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9212 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9213 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9214 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9215 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9216 redirected to another valid server.
9217
9218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9220
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009221 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009222
9223
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009224option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9225 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9226 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9227 yes | no | yes | yes
9228 Arguments :
9229 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9230 PostgreSQL server.
9231
9232 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9233 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9234 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9235 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9236
9237 See also: "option httpchk"
9238
9239
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009240option prefer-last-server
9241no option prefer-last-server
9242 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9244 yes | no | yes | yes
9245 Arguments : none
9246
9247 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
9248 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
9249 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9250 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9251 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9252 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9253 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9254 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9255 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009256 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9257 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009258 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9259 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9260 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009261 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9262 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9263 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009264
9265 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9266 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9267
9268 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9269
9270
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009271option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009272option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009273no option redispatch
9274 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9275 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9276 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009277 Arguments :
9278 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9279 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9280 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009281 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009282 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009283 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009284 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9285 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9286 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9287
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009288
9289 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9290 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9291 be able to access the service anymore.
9292
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009293 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9294 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009295
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009296 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9297 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9298 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9299 following order:
9300
9301 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9302
9303 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9304 list, or
9305
9306 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9307
9308 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9309 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9310
9311 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9312 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9313 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9314 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9315
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009316 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009317 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9318 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009319
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009320 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9321 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9322
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009323 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009324
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009325
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009326option redis-check
9327 Use redis health checks for server testing
9328 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9329 yes | no | yes | yes
9330 Arguments : none
9331
9332 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9333 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9334 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9335 find the "+PONG" response message.
9336
9337 Example :
9338 option redis-check
9339
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009340 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009341
9342
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009343option smtpchk
9344option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9345 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9346 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9347 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009348 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009349 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009350 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009351 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9352
9353 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9354 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9355 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9356
9357 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9358 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9359 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9360 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9361 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9362 dead server.
9363
9364 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9365 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009366 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009367 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9368
9369 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9370 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9371 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9372 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009373 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009374
9375 Example :
9376 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9377
9378 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9379
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009380
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009381option socket-stats
9382no option socket-stats
9383
9384 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9385 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9386 yes | yes | yes | no
9387
9388 Arguments : none
9389
9390
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009391option splice-auto
9392no option splice-auto
9393 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9394 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9395 yes | yes | yes | yes
9396 Arguments : none
9397
9398 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9399 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009400 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009401 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009402 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009403 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9404 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9405 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9406 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9407
9408 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9409 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9410 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9411 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9412 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9413 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9414 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9415 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9416 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9417 keyword.
9418
9419 Example :
9420 option splice-auto
9421
9422 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9423 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9424
9425 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9426 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9427
9428
9429option splice-request
9430no option splice-request
9431 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9432 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9433 yes | yes | yes | yes
9434 Arguments : none
9435
9436 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009437 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009438 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9439 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9440 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9441 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9442
9443 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9444
9445 Example :
9446 option splice-request
9447
9448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9450
9451 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9452 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9453
9454
9455option splice-response
9456no option splice-response
9457 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9459 yes | yes | yes | yes
9460 Arguments : none
9461
9462 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009463 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009464 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9465 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9466 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9467 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9468
9469 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9470
9471 Example :
9472 option splice-response
9473
9474 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9475 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9476
9477 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9478 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9479
9480
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009481option spop-check
9482 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9484 no | no | no | yes
9485 Arguments : none
9486
9487 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9488 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9489 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9490 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9491
9492 Example :
9493 option spop-check
9494
9495 See also : "option httpchk"
9496
9497
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009498option srvtcpka
9499no option srvtcpka
9500 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9501 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9502 yes | no | yes | yes
9503 Arguments : none
9504
9505 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9506 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009507 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009508 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9509
9510 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9511 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9512 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9513 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9514
9515 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9516 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9517 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9518 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9519 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9520
9521 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9522
9523 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9524 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9525 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9526
9527 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9528 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9529
9530 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9531
9532
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009533option ssl-hello-chk
9534 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9536 yes | no | yes | yes
9537 Arguments : none
9538
9539 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9540 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9541 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9542 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9543 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9544 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9545 hello message.
9546
9547 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9548 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9549 messages, which is appreciable.
9550
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009551 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9552 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9553 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009554
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009555 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9556
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009557
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009558option tcp-check
9559 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9560 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9561 yes | no | yes | yes
9562
9563 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9564 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9565
9566 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9567 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9568 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9569
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009570 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009571 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9572 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9573 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9574 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9575 only.
9576
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009577 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009578 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9579 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9580 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9581 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9582
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009583 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009584 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9585 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009586 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009587 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9588 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9589 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9590 the respective protocols.
9591 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009592 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009593
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009594 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009595
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009596 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9597 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9598 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9599 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009600
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009601 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9602 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9603 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009604
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009605
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009606 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009607 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009608 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009609 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009610
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009611 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009612 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009613 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009614
9615 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9616 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009617 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009618 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009619 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009620 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009621 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009622 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009623 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9624 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009625 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009626 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9627 tcp-check expect string +OK
9628
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009629 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009630 (send many headers before analyzing)
9631 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009632 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009633 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9634 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9635 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9636 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009637 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009638
9639
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009640 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009641
9642
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009643option tcp-smart-accept
9644no option tcp-smart-accept
9645 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9647 yes | yes | yes | no
9648 Arguments : none
9649
9650 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9651 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9652 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9653 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9654 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9655 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9656
9657 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9658 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9659 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9660 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9661
9662 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9663 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9664 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009665 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009666
9667 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9668 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9669 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9670
9671 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9672 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9673 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9674
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009675 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9676
9677
9678option tcp-smart-connect
9679no option tcp-smart-connect
9680 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9682 yes | no | yes | yes
9683 Arguments : none
9684
9685 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9686 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9687 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9688 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9689 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9690
9691 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9692 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9693 complex.
9694
9695 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9696 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9697 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9698
9699 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9700 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9701
9702 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9703
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009704
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009705option tcpka
9706 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9708 yes | yes | yes | yes
9709 Arguments : none
9710
9711 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9712 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009713 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009714 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9715
9716 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9717 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9718 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9719 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9720
9721 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9722 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9723 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9724 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9725 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9726
9727 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9728
9729 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9730 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9731 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9732 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9733 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9734 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9735 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9736 backends.
9737
9738 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9739
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009740
9741option tcplog
9742 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009744 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009745 Arguments : none
9746
9747 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9748 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9749 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9750 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9751 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9752 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9753 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9754 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9755
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009756 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9757
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009758 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009759
9760
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009761option transparent
9762no option transparent
9763 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009765 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009766 Arguments : none
9767
9768 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9769 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9770 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9771 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9772 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9773 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9774 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9775 appropriate server.
9776
9777 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9778 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9779
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009780 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009781 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009782
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009783
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009784external-check command <command>
9785 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9786 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9787 yes | no | yes | yes
9788
9789 Arguments :
9790 <command> is the external command to run
9791
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009792 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9793
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009794 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009795
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009796 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9797 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9798 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9799 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9800 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9801 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009802
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009803 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9804
9805 Environment variables :
9806 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9807 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9808
9809 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9810
9811 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9812
9813 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9814 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9815 for a UNIX socket).
9816
9817 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9818
9819 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9820
9821 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9822
9823 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9824
9825 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9826
9827 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9828 socket).
9829
9830 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9831 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9832
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009833 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9834
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009835 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9836 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9837 failed.
9838
9839 Example :
9840 external-check command /bin/true
9841
9842 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9843
9844
9845external-check path <path>
9846 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9847 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9848 yes | no | yes | yes
9849
9850 Arguments :
9851 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9852
9853 The default path is "".
9854
9855 Example :
9856 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9857
9858 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9859 "external-check command"
9860
9861
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009862persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009863persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009864 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9865 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9866 yes | no | yes | yes
9867 Arguments :
9868 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009869 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9870 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009871
9872 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9873 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009874 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009875 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9876 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9877 forwarded to this server.
9878
9879 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9880 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9881 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009882 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009883 a single "listen" section.
9884
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009885 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9886 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9887 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9888
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009889 Example :
9890 listen tse-farm
9891 bind :3389
9892 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9893 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9894 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9895 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9896 persist rdp-cookie
9897 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009898 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009899 balance rdp-cookie
9900 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9901 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9902
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009903 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9904 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009905
9906
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009907rate-limit sessions <rate>
9908 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9909 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9910 yes | yes | yes | no
9911 Arguments :
9912 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9913 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9914
9915 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9916 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9917 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9918 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9919 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9920 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9921
9922 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9923 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9924 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9925 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9926
9927 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9928 listen smtp
9929 mode tcp
9930 bind :25
9931 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009932 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009933
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009934 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9935 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9936 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009937
9938 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9939
9940
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009941redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9942redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9943redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009944 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9946 no | yes | yes | yes
9947
9948 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009949 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009950
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009951 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009952 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009953 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9954 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9955 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009956
9957 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9958 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9959 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9960 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9961 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009962 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9963 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9964 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9965 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009966
9967 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9968 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9969 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9970 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9971 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9972 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009973 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009974 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009975 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9976 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9977 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009978
9979 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009980 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9981 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9982 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009983 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009984 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9985 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9986 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9987 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009988
9989 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009990 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009991
9992 - "drop-query"
9993 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9994 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9995 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9996 with a location-type redirect.
9997
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009998 - "append-slash"
9999 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10000 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10001 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10002 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10003
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010004 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10005 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10006 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10007 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10008 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10009 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10010 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10011
10012 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10013 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10014 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10015 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10016 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10017 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10018 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010019
10020 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10021 acl clear dst_port 80
10022 acl secure dst_port 8080
10023 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010024 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010025 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010026 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10027
10028 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010029 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10030 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10031 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010032 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010033
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010034 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10035 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10036 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10037
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010038 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010039 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010040
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010041 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010042 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10043 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10044 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010045
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010046 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010047
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010048
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010049retries <value>
10050 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10051 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10052 yes | no | yes | yes
10053 Arguments :
10054 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10055 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10056 default value is 3.
10057
10058 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10059 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10060 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10061
10062 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010063 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10064 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010065
10066 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10067 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10068
10069 See also : "option redispatch"
10070
10071
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010072retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010073 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10074 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10075 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010076 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10077 yes | no | yes | yes
10078 Arguments :
10079 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
10080 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
10081 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
10082 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
10083
10084 none never retry
10085
10086 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10087 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10088
10089 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10090 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10091 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10092 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10093 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10094 processing the request.
10095
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010096 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10097 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10098 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10099 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10100 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10101 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10102 overflow attack for example).
10103
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010104 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10105 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10106 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10107 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10108 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10109 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10110 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10111 amplify denial of service attacks.
10112
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010113 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10114 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10115 considered to be safe to retry.
10116
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010117 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10118 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10119 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10120 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10121 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010122
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010123 all-retryable-errors
10124 retry request for any error that are considered
10125 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10126 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10127 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10128
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010129 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10130 not cumulative.
10131
10132 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10133 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10134 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10135 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10136
10137 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10138 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10139 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10140 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10141 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10142 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10143 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10144 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10145 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10146 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10147 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10148 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10149
10150 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10151 should not use this directive.
10152
10153 The default is "conn-failure".
10154
10155 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10156
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010157server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010158 Declare a server in a backend
10159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10160 no | no | yes | yes
10161 Arguments :
10162 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010163 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010164 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010165
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010166 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10167 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10168 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10169 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010170 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10171 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
10172 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
10173 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10174 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010175 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10176 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10177 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10178 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10179 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10180 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10181 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010182 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010183 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10184 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10185 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10186 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10187 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10188 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010189 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10190 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010191 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10192 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010193
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010194 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010195 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10196 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10197 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10198 adding this value to the client's port.
10199
10200 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10201 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010202 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010203
10204 Examples :
10205 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10206 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010207 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010208 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10209 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10210 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010211
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010212 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10213 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10214 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10215 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10216 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10217
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010218 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10219 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010220
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010221server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010222 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010223 this backend.
10224 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10225 no | no | yes | yes
10226
10227 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10228 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10229 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10230 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10231 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010232
10233 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10234 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10235
10236 global
10237 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10238
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010239 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010240 load-server-state-from-file
10241
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010242 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010243 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010244
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010245server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10246 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10247 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10249 no | no | yes | yes
10250
10251 Arguments:
10252 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10253
10254 <num | range>
10255 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10256 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10257 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10258 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10259
10260 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10261
10262 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10263
10264 <params*>
10265 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10266 keyword.
10267
10268 Examples:
10269 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10270 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10271 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10272
10273 # or
10274 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10275
10276 # would be equivalent to:
10277 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10278 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10279 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10280
10281
10282
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010283source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010284source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010285source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010286 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10287 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10288 yes | no | yes | yes
10289 Arguments :
10290 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10291 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010292
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010293 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010294 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10295 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10296 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10297 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10298 supported prefixes are :
10299 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10300 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10301 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010302 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010303 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10304 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010305
10306 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10307 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010308 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10309 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10310 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010311
10312 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10313 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10314 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10315 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10316 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10317 <addr>.
10318
10319 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10320 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10321 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10322 port.
10323
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010324 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10325 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10326 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10327 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010328 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010329 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10330 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10331 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10332 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10333 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10334 HTTP header.
10335
10336 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10337 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010338 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010339 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10340 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10341 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10342 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10343 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10344 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10345 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10346
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010347 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10348 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10349 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10350 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10351 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10352 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10353
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010354 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10355 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10356 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10357 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10358
10359 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10360 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10361 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10362 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10363 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10364 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10365
10366 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10367 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10368 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10369 there are two methods :
10370
10371 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10372 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10373 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10374 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10375 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10376 of the client ranges may be used.
10377
10378 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10379 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10380 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10381 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10382 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10383 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10384 same session.
10385
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010386 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10387 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10388 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010389 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010390
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010391 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10392
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010393 Examples :
10394 backend private
10395 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10396 source 192.168.1.200
10397
10398 backend transparent_ssl1
10399 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10400 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10401
10402 backend transparent_ssl2
10403 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10404 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10405 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10406
10407 backend transparent_ssl3
10408 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10409 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10410 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10411
10412 backend transparent_smtp
10413 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10414 # with Tproxy version 4.
10415 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10416
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010417 backend transparent_http
10418 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10419 # proxy.
10420 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010422 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010423 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10424
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010425
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010426srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10427 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10428 the connection on the server side.
10429 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10430 yes | no | yes | yes
10431 Arguments :
10432 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10433
10434 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10435 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010436 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10437 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010438
10439 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10440
10441
10442srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10443 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10444 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10445 server side.
10446 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10447 yes | no | yes | yes
10448 Arguments :
10449 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10450 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10451 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10452 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10453
10454 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10455 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010456 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10457 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010458
10459 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10460
10461
10462srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10463 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10464 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10465 yes | no | yes | yes
10466 Arguments :
10467 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10468 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10469 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10470 document.
10471
10472 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10473 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010474 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10475 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010476
10477 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10478
10479
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010480stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10481 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010483 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010484
10485 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10486 matched.
10487
10488 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10489 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10490
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010491 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10492 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010493 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010494
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010495 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10496 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10497 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10498 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010499
10500 Example :
10501 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10502 backend stats_localhost
10503 stats enable
10504 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10505
10506 Example :
10507 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10508 backend stats_auth
10509 stats enable
10510 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10511 stats admin if TRUE
10512
10513 Example :
10514 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10515 userlist stats-auth
10516 group admin users admin
10517 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10518 group readonly users haproxy
10519 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10520
10521 backend stats_auth
10522 stats enable
10523 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10524 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10525 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10526 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10527
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010528 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10529 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10530 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010531
10532
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010533stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10534 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010536 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010537 Arguments :
10538 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10539
10540 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10541
10542 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10543 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10544 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10545 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10546 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10547 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10548
10549 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10550 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10551 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010552 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010553
10554 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10555 report using "stats scope".
10556
10557 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10558 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10559 unobvious parameters.
10560
10561 Example :
10562 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10563 backend public_www
10564 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10565 stats enable
10566 stats hide-version
10567 stats scope .
10568 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010569 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010570 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10571 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10572
10573 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10574 backend private_monitoring
10575 stats enable
10576 stats uri /admin?stats
10577 stats refresh 5s
10578
10579 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10580
10581
10582stats enable
10583 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10584 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010585 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010586 Arguments : none
10587
10588 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10589 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10590 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10591 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10592 - stats auth : no authentication
10593 - stats scope : no restriction
10594
10595 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10596 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10597 unobvious parameters.
10598
10599 Example :
10600 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10601 backend public_www
10602 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10603 stats enable
10604 stats hide-version
10605 stats scope .
10606 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010607 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010608 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10609 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10610
10611 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10612 backend private_monitoring
10613 stats enable
10614 stats uri /admin?stats
10615 stats refresh 5s
10616
10617 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10618
10619
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010620stats hide-version
10621 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010623 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010624 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010625
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010626 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10627 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10628 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10629 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10630 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10631 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010632
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010633 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10634 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10635 unobvious parameters.
10636
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010637 Example :
10638 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10639 backend public_www
10640 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010641 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010642 stats hide-version
10643 stats scope .
10644 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010645 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010646 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10647 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010648
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010649 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10650 backend private_monitoring
10651 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010652 stats uri /admin?stats
10653 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010654
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010655 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010656
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010657
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010658stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10659 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10660 Access control for statistics
10661
10662 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10663 no | no | yes | yes
10664
10665 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10666 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10667 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10668 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10669 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10670 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10671
10672 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10673 instance.
10674
10675 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10676 about ACL usage.
10677
10678
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010679stats realm <realm>
10680 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010682 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010683 Arguments :
10684 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10685 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10686 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10687
10688 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10689 using a backslash ('\').
10690
10691 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10692 only related to authentication.
10693
10694 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10695 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10696 unobvious parameters.
10697
10698 Example :
10699 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10700 backend public_www
10701 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10702 stats enable
10703 stats hide-version
10704 stats scope .
10705 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010706 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010707 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10708 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10709
10710 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10711 backend private_monitoring
10712 stats enable
10713 stats uri /admin?stats
10714 stats refresh 5s
10715
10716 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10717
10718
10719stats refresh <delay>
10720 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010722 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010723 Arguments :
10724 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10725 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10726 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10727 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10728 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10729 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10730
10731 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10732 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10733 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010734 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010735
10736 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10737 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10738 unobvious parameters.
10739
10740 Example :
10741 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10742 backend public_www
10743 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10744 stats enable
10745 stats hide-version
10746 stats scope .
10747 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010748 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010749 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10750 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10751
10752 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10753 backend private_monitoring
10754 stats enable
10755 stats uri /admin?stats
10756 stats refresh 5s
10757
10758 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10759
10760
10761stats scope { <name> | "." }
10762 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10763 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010764 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010765 Arguments :
10766 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10767 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10768 section in which the statement appears.
10769
10770 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10771 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10772 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10773 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10774 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10775 exists.
10776
10777 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10778 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10779 unobvious parameters.
10780
10781 Example :
10782 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10783 backend public_www
10784 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10785 stats enable
10786 stats hide-version
10787 stats scope .
10788 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010789 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010790 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10791 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10792
10793 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10794 backend private_monitoring
10795 stats enable
10796 stats uri /admin?stats
10797 stats refresh 5s
10798
10799 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10800
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010801
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010802stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010803 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010805 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010806
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010807 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010808 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10809
10810 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10811 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10812
10813 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10814 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010815 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010816
10817 Example :
10818 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10819 backend private_monitoring
10820 stats enable
10821 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10822 stats uri /admin?stats
10823 stats refresh 5s
10824
10825 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10826 global section.
10827
10828
10829stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010830 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10831 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10832 yes | yes | yes | yes
10833 Arguments : none
10834
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010835 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010836 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10837 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10838 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10839 - IP (socket, server)
10840 - cookie (backend, server)
10841
10842 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10843 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010844 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010845
10846 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10847
10848
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010849stats show-modules
10850 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10852 yes | yes | yes | yes
10853 Arguments : none
10854
10855 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10856 values as a tooltip.
10857
10858 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10859 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10860 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10861
10862 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10863
10864
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010865stats show-node [ <name> ]
10866 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010868 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010869 Arguments:
10870 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10871 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10872
10873 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10874 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010875 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010876
10877 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10878 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10879 unobvious parameters.
10880
10881 Example:
10882 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10883 backend private_monitoring
10884 stats enable
10885 stats show-node Europe-1
10886 stats uri /admin?stats
10887 stats refresh 5s
10888
10889 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10890 section.
10891
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010892
10893stats uri <prefix>
10894 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010896 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010897 Arguments :
10898 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10899 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10900 query string.
10901
10902 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10903 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10904 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10905 possible to reach it in the application.
10906
10907 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010908 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010909 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10910 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10911 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10912 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10913
10914 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10915 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10916 an address or a port to statistics only.
10917
10918 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10919 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10920 unobvious parameters.
10921
10922 Example :
10923 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10924 backend public_www
10925 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10926 stats enable
10927 stats hide-version
10928 stats scope .
10929 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010930 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010931 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10932 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10933
10934 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10935 backend private_monitoring
10936 stats enable
10937 stats uri /admin?stats
10938 stats refresh 5s
10939
10940 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10941
10942
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010943stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10944 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010945 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010946 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010947
10948 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010949 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010950 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010951 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010952 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10953
10954 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10955 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10956 the "stick-table" statement.
10957
10958 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10959 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10960 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10961 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10962 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10963
10964 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10965 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10966 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10967 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10968 transformation rules.
10969
10970 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10971 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10972 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10973 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10974 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10975 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10976 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10977
10978 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10979 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10980 ACL based conditions.
10981
10982 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10983 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10984 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10985 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10986
10987 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10988 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10989 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10990 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10991
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010992 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10993 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010994 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010995
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010996 Example :
10997 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10998 # last 30 minutes
10999 backend pop
11000 mode tcp
11001 balance roundrobin
11002 stick store-request src
11003 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11004 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11005 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11006
11007 backend smtp
11008 mode tcp
11009 balance roundrobin
11010 stick match src table pop
11011 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11012 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11013
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011014 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011015 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011016
11017
11018stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11019 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11021 no | no | yes | yes
11022
11023 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11024 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11025 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11026 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11027
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011028 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11029 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011030 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011031
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011032 Examples :
11033 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011034 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011035
11036 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11037 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11038 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11039
11040
11041 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11042 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11043 backend http
11044 mode http
11045 balance roundrobin
11046 stick on src table https
11047 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11048 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11049 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11050
11051 backend https
11052 mode tcp
11053 balance roundrobin
11054 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11055 stick on src
11056 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11057 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11058
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011059 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011060
11061
11062stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11063 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11064 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11065 no | no | yes | yes
11066
11067 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011068 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011069 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011070 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011071 server is selected.
11072
11073 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11074 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11075 the "stick-table" statement.
11076
11077 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11078 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11079 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11080 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11081 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11082 address.
11083
11084 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11085 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11086 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11087 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11088 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11089 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11090 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11091 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11092 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11093 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11094
11095 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11096 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11097 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11098 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11099 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11100 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11101 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11102
11103 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11104 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11105 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11106 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11107
11108 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11109 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11110 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11111 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11112 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11113 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011114 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11115 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11116 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11117 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11118 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11119 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011120
11121 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11122 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11123 the request.
11124
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011125 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11126 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011127 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011128
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011129 Example :
11130 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11131 # last 30 minutes
11132 backend pop
11133 mode tcp
11134 balance roundrobin
11135 stick store-request src
11136 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11137 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11138 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11139
11140 backend smtp
11141 mode tcp
11142 balance roundrobin
11143 stick match src table pop
11144 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11145 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11146
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011147 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011148 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011149
11150
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011151stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011152 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011153 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011154 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011156 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011157
11158 Arguments :
11159 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11160 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11161 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11162 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11163
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011164 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11165 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11166 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11167 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11168
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011169 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11170 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11171 instance.
11172
11173 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11174 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11175 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11176 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11177 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11178 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011179 to 32 characters.
11180
11181 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11182 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11183 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011184 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011185 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11186 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011187
11188 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011189 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11190 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011191 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11192 increase.
11193
11194 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011195 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11196 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11197 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011198
11199 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
11200 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
11201 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11202 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011203 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011204 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11205 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11206 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11207 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11208 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11209 parameter (see below).
11210
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011211 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11212 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11213 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11214 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11215 soft restart.
11216
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011217 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11218 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011219
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011220 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11221 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11222 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11223 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011224 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011225 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011226 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11227 if not expiration delay is specified.
11228
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011229 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11230 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11231 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11232 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11233 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11234 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11235 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11236 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11237 token.
11238
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011239 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11240 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11241 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11242 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011243 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11244 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11245 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11246 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11247 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11248 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11249 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11250 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11251 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11252 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11253 types and their arguments.
11254
11255 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11256 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11257 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11258 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11259
11260 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11261 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11262 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011263 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011264
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011265 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11266 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11267 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011268 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011269 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011270 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011271
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011272 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11273 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11274 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11275 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11276
11277 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11278 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11279 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11280 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11281 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11282 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11283
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011284 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11285 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11286 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11287 they were received.
11288
11289 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11290 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11291 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11292 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11293 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11294
11295 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11296 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11297 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11298 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11299 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11300
11301 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11302 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11303 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11304
11305 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11306 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11307 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11308 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11309 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11310
11311 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11312 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11313 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11314 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11315 the client side.
11316
11317 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11318 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11319 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11320 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11321 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11322 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11323 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11324
11325 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11326 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11327 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11328 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11329 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11330 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011331 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011332
11333 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11334 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11335 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11336 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11337 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11338 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11339
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011340 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11341 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11342 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11343 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11344 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11345
11346 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11347 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11348 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11349 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11350 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11351 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11352
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011353 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011354 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011355 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11356 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11357
11358 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11359 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11360 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11361 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11362 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11363 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11364 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11365 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11366 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11367 recommended for better fairness.
11368
11369 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011370 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011371 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11372 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11373
11374 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11375 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11376 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11377 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11378 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11379 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11380 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11381 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11382 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11383 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011384
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011385 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11386 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011387 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11388 reference it.
11389
11390 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11391 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011392 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11393 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11394 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011395
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011396 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11397 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11398 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11399 something that can be ignored.
11400
11401 Example:
11402 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11403 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11404 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11405 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11406
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011407 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011408 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011409
11410
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011411stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011412 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11414 no | no | yes | yes
11415
11416 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011417 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011418 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011419 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011420 server is selected.
11421
11422 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11423 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11424 the "stick-table" statement.
11425
11426 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11427 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11428 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11429 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11430
11431 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11432 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11433 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11434 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11435 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11436 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011437 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011438 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11439 rules.
11440
11441 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11442 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11443 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11444 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11445 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11446 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11447 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11448
11449 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11450 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11451 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11452 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11453
11454 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11455 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11456 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11457 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11458 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11459 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011460 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11461 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11462 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11463 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11464 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11465 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11466 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11467 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11468 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011469
11470 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11471
11472 Example :
11473 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11474 backend https
11475 mode tcp
11476 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011477 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011478 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011479
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011480 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11481 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11482
11483 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11484 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11485 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11486
11487 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11488 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011489
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011490 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11491 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11492 # at offset 44.
11493
11494 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11495 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11496
11497 # Learn on response if server hello.
11498 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011499
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011500 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11501 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11502
11503 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11504 extraction.
11505
11506
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011507tcp-check comment <string>
11508 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11509 it fails.
11510 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11511 yes | no | yes | yes
11512
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011513 Arguments :
11514 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11515 rule fails.
11516
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011517 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11518 user-friendly error reporting.
11519
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011520 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11521 "tcp-check expect".
11522
11523
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011524tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11525 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011526 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011527 Opens a new connection
11528 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011529 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011530
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011531 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011532 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11533
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011534 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011535 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011536
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011537 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011538 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11539 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011540 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011541
11542 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011543
11544 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11545
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011546 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11547
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011548 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11549
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011550 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11551
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011552 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11553 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11554 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11555 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11556
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011557 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11558 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11559 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11560 haproxy -vv.
11561
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011562 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011563
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011564 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11565 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11566 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11567
11568 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11569 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11570 of the sequence.
11571
11572 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11573 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11574 do.
11575
11576 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11577 unset-var or comment rules.
11578
11579 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011580 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11581 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11582 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11583 option tcp-check
11584 tcp-check connect
11585 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11586 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11587 tcp-check send \r\n
11588 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11589 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11590 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11591 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11592 tcp-check send \r\n
11593 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11594 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11595
11596 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11597 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011598 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011599 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11600 tcp-check connect port 143
11601 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11602 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11603
11604 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11605
11606
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011607tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011608 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011609 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011610 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011611 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011612 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011613 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011614
11615 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011616 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11617
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011618 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11619 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11620 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11621 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11622 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11623 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11624 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11625 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11626 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11627 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11628
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011629 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011630 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11631 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011632 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11633 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11634 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11635
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011636 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11637 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11638 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011639 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11640 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011641 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11642 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011643 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11644 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011645 By default "L7OK" is used.
11646
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011647 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11648 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011649 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11650 supported :
11651 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11652 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011653 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11654 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11655 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11656 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11657 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011658
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011659 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011660 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011661 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11662 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11663 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11664 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011665 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11666
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011667 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11668 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11669 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11670 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11671
11672 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11673 informational message reported in logs if an error
11674 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11675 log-format string.
11676
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011677 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11678 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11679 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11680 followed by some converters.
11681
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011682 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11683 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11684 with the usual backslash ('\').
11685 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011686 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011687 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11688 used upper or lower case.
11689
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011690 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11691
11692 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11693 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11694 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11695 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11696 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11697 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11698 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11699 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11700
11701 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11702 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11703 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11704 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11705 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11706 expression.
11707
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011708 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11709 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11710 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11711 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11712 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11713 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11714
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011715 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11716 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11717 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11718 this exact hexadecimal string.
11719 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11720
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011721 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11722 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11723 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11724 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11725 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11726 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11727 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11728 size.
11729
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011730 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11731 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11732 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11733 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11734 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11735 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11736 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11737 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11738 in a binary string before matching the response's
11739 buffer.
11740
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011741 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011742 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011743 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11744 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11745 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11746 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11747 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11748 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11749 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11750 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11751 the null character.
11752
11753 Examples :
11754 # perform a POP check
11755 option tcp-check
11756 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11757
11758 # perform an IMAP check
11759 option tcp-check
11760 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11761
11762 # look for the redis master server
11763 option tcp-check
11764 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011765 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011766 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11767 tcp-check expect string role:master
11768 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11769 tcp-check expect string +OK
11770
11771
11772 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011773 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011774
11775
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011776tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11777tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11778 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11779 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011780 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011781 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011782
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011783 Arguments :
11784 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11785
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011786 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11787 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011788
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011789 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11790 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011791
11792 Examples :
11793 # look for the redis master server
11794 option tcp-check
11795 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11796 tcp-check expect string role:master
11797
11798 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011799 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011800
11801
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011802tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11803tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11804 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11805 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011806 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011807 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011808
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011809 Arguments :
11810 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011811
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011812 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11813 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011814
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011815 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11816 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11817 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011818
11819 Examples :
11820 # redis check in binary
11821 option tcp-check
11822 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11823 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11824
11825
11826 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011827 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011828
11829
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011830tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011831 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011832 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011833 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011834
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011835 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011836 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11837 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11838 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11839 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11840 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11841 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11842 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11843 and '-'.
11844
11845 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11846
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011847 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011848 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11849
11850
11851tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011852 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011853 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011854 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011855
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011856 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011857 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11858 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11859 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11860 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11861 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11863 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11864 and '-'.
11865
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011866 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011867 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11868
11869
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011870tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11871 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011872 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11873 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011874 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011875 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11876 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011877
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011878 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011879
11880 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11881 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011882 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11883 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11884 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11885 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11886 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11887 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011888
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011889 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11890 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11891 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11892 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011893
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011894 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011895 - accept :
11896 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11897 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11898 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011899
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011900 - reject :
11901 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11902 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11903 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11904 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11905 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11906 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11907 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11908 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11909 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11910 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11911 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011912 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011913
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011914 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11915 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11916 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11917 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11918 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11919 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11920 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11921 hosts.
11922
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011923 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11924 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11925 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11926 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11927 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11928 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11929 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11930 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11931
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011932 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11933 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11934 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11935 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11936 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11937 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11938 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11939 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11940 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011941 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11942 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011943
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011944 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011945 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011946 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11947 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11948 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011949 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011950 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011951 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11952 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11953 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11954 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11955 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11956 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11957 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011958
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011959 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011960 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011961 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011962 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011963 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11964 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11965 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011966
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011967 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11968 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11969 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11970 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011971
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011972 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11973 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11974 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11975 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11976 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011977 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11978 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11979 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11980 layer7 information is extracted.
11981
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011982 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11983 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11984 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11985 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11986 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011987
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011988 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11989 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11990 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11991 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11992
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011993 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11994 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11995 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11996 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11997
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011998 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11999 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12000 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12001 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12002 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012003
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012004 - set-src <expr> :
12005 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12006 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12007 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012008 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012009
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012010 Arguments:
12011 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12012 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012013
12014 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012015 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12016
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012017 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12018 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012019
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012020 - set-src-port <expr> :
12021 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12022 expression.
12023
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012024 Arguments:
12025 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12026 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012027
12028 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012029 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12030
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012031 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12032 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12033 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012034
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012035 - set-dst <expr> :
12036 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12037 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12038 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12039 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12040 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12041
12042 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12043 followed by some converters.
12044
12045 Example:
12046
12047 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12048 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12049
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012050 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12051 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12052
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012053 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12054 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12055 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12056 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12057
12058
12059 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12060 followed by some converters.
12061
12062 Example:
12063
12064 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12065
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012066 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12067 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12068 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12069
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012070 - "silent-drop" :
12071 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012072 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012073 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12074 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12075 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12076 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12077 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012078 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12079 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012080 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12081 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012082 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012083 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12084 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12085 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12086 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12087
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012088 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12089 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12090 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012091
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012092 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12093 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12094 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012095
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012096 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012097 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012098 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012100 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12101 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12102 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012103
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012104 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012105 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12106 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012107
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012108 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12109
12110 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12111
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012112 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12113
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012114 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012115
12116
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012117tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12118 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012119 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012120 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012121 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012122 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12123 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012124
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012125 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012126
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012127 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012128 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12129 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012130 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12131 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012132
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012133 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12134 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12135 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12136 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012137 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
12138 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
12139 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12140 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12141 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12142 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012143 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012144 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012145
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012146 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12147 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12148 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12149 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012150
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012151 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012152 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012153 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012154 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12155 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012156 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012157 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012158 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012159 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012160 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012161 - set-dst <expr>
12162 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012163 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012164 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012165 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012166 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012167 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012168 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012169
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012170 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12171 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012172 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12173 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012174
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012175 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12176 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12177 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12178 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12179 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12180 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012181
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012182 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012183 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12184 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012185
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012186 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12187 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12188 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12189 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12190 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12191 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12192
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012193 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012194 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12195 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12196 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12197 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12198 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12199 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12200 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12201 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12202 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12203 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012204
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012205 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012206 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12207 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12208 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012209
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012210 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12211 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12212
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012213 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012214 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12215 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012216
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012217 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12218 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012219 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012220 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12221 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012222 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012223 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012224 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012225 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12226 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012227 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012228 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12229 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012230
12231 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12232 followed by some converters.
12233
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012234 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
12235 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12236 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12237 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12238 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12239 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12240 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +050012241 warning. These directives will be conditionaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012242 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12243 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12244
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012245 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12246
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012247 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12248 <var-name>.
12249
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012250 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12251 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12252 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12253 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12254 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12255
12256 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12257 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12258 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12259 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12260 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12261 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12262 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12263 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12264 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12265 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12266 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12267
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012268 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12269 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12270 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12271 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12272 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12273
12274 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12275
12276 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12277
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012278 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12279 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12280 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12281 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12282 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12283 evaluated.
12284
12285 Example:
12286 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12287
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012288 Example:
12289
12290 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012291 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012292
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012293 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012294 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012295 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012296 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12297 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012298 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012299 tcp-request content reject
12300
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012301 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12302 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12303 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12304 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12305 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12306 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12307 ...
12308 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12309
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012310 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012311 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12312 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12313 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012314 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012315
12316 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12317 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12318 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012319 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012320 tcp-request content reject
12321
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012322 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012323 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012324 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012325 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012326 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12327 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012328
12329 Example:
12330 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12331 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012332 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012333
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012334 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012335 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012336
12337 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012338 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012339 # protecting all our sites
12340 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012341 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12342 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012343 ...
12344 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12345
12346 backend http_dynamic
12347 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012348 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012349 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012350 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012351 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012352 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012353 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012355 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012356
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012357 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12358 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012359
12360
12361tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12362 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012364 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012365 Arguments :
12366 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12367 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12368 as explained at the top of this document.
12369
12370 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12371 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12372 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12373 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12374 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12375
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012376 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12377 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12378 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12379 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12380
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012381 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12382 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012383 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012384 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012385 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12386 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12387 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12388 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012389
12390 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12391 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12392 it pass through unaffected.
12393
12394 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12395 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12396 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012397 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012398 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12399 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012400 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12401 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12402 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012403
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012404 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012405 "timeout client".
12406
12407
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012408tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12409 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12411 no | no | yes | yes
12412 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012413 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12414 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012415
12416 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12417
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012418 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012419 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12420 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012421 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12422 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012423
12424 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12425
12426 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12427 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12428 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12429 inserted.
12430
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012431 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012432 - accept :
12433 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12434 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12435 the rules evaluation.
12436
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012437 - close :
12438 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12439 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12440 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12441 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12442 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12443 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012444 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012445 protocols.
12446
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012447 - reject :
12448 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12449 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012450 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012451
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012452 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12453 Sets a variable.
12454
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012455 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12456 Unsets a variable.
12457
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012458 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12459 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12460 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12461 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12462
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012463 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12464 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12465 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12466 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12467
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012468 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12469 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12470 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12471 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12472 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012473
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012474 - "silent-drop" :
12475 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012476 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012477 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12478 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12479 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12480 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12481 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012482 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12483 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012484 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12485 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012486 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012487 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12488 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12489 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12490 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12491
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012492 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12493 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12494
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012495 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12496 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12497 for changing the default action to a reject.
12498
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012499 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12500 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12501 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12502 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012503 period.
12504
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012505 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12506 declared inline.
12507
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012508 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12509 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012510 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012511 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12512 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012513 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012514 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012515 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012516 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12517 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012518 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012519 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12520 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012521
12522 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12523 followed by some converters.
12524
12525 Example:
12526
12527 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12528
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012529 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12530 <var-name>.
12531
12532 Example:
12533
12534 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12535
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012536 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12537 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12538 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12539 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12540 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12541
12542 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12543
12544 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12545
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012546 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12547
12548 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12549
12550
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012551tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12552 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12554 no | yes | yes | no
12555 Arguments :
12556 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12557 below.
12558
12559 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12560
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012561 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012562 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12563 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12564 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12565 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12566 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12567 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12568 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012569 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012570 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12571 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12572 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12573 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12574 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12575 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12576 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12577 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12578 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12579 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12580 instead.
12581
12582 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12583 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12584 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12585 rules which may be inserted.
12586
12587 Several types of actions are supported :
12588 - accept : the request is accepted
12589 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12590 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12591 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012592 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012593 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012594 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012595 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012596 - silent-drop
12597
12598 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12599 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12600 sections for a complete description.
12601
12602 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12603 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12604 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12605
12606 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12607 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12608 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12609 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12610 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12611
12612 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12613 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12614
12615 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12616 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12617 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12618
12619 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12620 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12621 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12622
12623 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12624 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12625 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12626
12627 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12628 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12629 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12630
12631 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12632
12633 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12634
12635
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012636tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12637 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12639 no | no | yes | yes
12640 Arguments :
12641 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12642 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12643 as explained at the top of this document.
12644
12645 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12646
12647
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012648timeout check <timeout>
12649 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12650 established.
12651
12652 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12653 yes | no | yes | yes
12654 Arguments:
12655 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12656 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12657 as explained at the top of this document.
12658
12659 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12660 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012661 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012662 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012663 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12664 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12665 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012666
12667 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12668 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12669
12670 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12671 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012672 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012673
12674 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12675 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12676 forget about it.
12677
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012678 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12679 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012680
12681
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012682timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012683 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12685 yes | yes | yes | no
12686 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012687 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012688 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12689 as explained at the top of this document.
12690
12691 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12692 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12693 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012694 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12695 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12696 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12697 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012698 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12699 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12700 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012701 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012702 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012703 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12704 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012705 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12706 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012707
12708 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12709 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12710 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12711 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012712 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012713 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12714
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012715 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012716
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012717 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012718
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012719
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012720timeout client-fin <timeout>
12721 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12722 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12723 yes | yes | yes | no
12724 Arguments :
12725 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12726 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12727 as explained at the top of this document.
12728
12729 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12730 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12731 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12732 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12733 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12734 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12735 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012736 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12737 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12738 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012739
12740 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12741 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12742 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12743
12744 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12745
12746
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012747timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012748 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12749 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12750 yes | no | yes | yes
12751 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012752 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012753 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12754 as explained at the top of this document.
12755
12756 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012757 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012758 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012759 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012760 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12761 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012762
12763 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12764 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12765 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12766 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012767 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012768 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12769
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012770 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012771
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012772
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012773timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12774 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12776 yes | yes | yes | yes
12777 Arguments :
12778 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12779 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12780 as explained at the top of this document.
12781
12782 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12783 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12784 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12785 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12786 once the request has started to present itself.
12787
12788 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12789 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12790 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12791 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12792 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12793
12794 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12795 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12796 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12797 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12798
12799 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12800 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012801 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012802 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12803 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012804 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012805
12806 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12807 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12808 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12809 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12810
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012811 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12812 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012813 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12814
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012815 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12816
12817
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012818timeout http-request <timeout>
12819 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012821 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012822 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012823 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012824 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12825 as explained at the top of this document.
12826
12827 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12828 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12829 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12830 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12831 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12832 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12833 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012834 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12835 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12836 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12837 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012838 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012839 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12840 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012841
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012842 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12843 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12844 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12845 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12846 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012847 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012848
12849 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12850 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012851 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012852 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12853 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12854
12855 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012856 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12857 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12858 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012859
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012860 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012861 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012862
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012863
12864timeout queue <timeout>
12865 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12866 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12867 yes | no | yes | yes
12868 Arguments :
12869 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12870 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12871 as explained at the top of this document.
12872
12873 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12874 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12875 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12876 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12877 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12878
12879 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12880 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12881 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12882 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12883
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012884 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012885
12886
12887timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012888 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12889 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12890 yes | no | yes | yes
12891 Arguments :
12892 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12893 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12894 as explained at the top of this document.
12895
12896 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12897 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12898 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12899 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12900 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12901 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12902 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12903
12904 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12905 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12906 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12907 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12908 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012909 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012910 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012911 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12912 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012913 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12914 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012915
12916 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12917 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12918 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12919 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012920 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012921 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12922
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012923 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012924
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012925
12926timeout server-fin <timeout>
12927 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12929 yes | no | yes | yes
12930 Arguments :
12931 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12932 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12933 as explained at the top of this document.
12934
12935 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12936 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12937 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12938 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12939 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12940 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12941 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12942 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12943 situations, it should not be needed.
12944
12945 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12946 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12947 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12948
12949 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12950
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012951
12952timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012953 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12955 yes | yes | yes | yes
12956 Arguments :
12957 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12958 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12959 as explained at the top of this document.
12960
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012961 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12962 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12963 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012964
12965 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12966 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12967 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12968 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012969 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012970
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012971 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012972
12973
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012974timeout tunnel <timeout>
12975 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12976 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12977 yes | no | yes | yes
12978 Arguments :
12979 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12980 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12981 as explained at the top of this document.
12982
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012983 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012984 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12985 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12986 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012987 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12988 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012989 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12990 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12991 specified.
12992
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012993 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12994 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12995 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12996 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12997 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12998 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12999 state.
13000
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013001 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13002 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13003 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13004 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013005 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013006
13007 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13008 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13009 forget about it.
13010
13011 Example :
13012 defaults http
13013 option http-server-close
13014 timeout connect 5s
13015 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013016 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013017 timeout server 30s
13018 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13019
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013020 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013021
13022
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013023transparent (deprecated)
13024 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013026 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013027 Arguments : none
13028
13029 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13030 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13031 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13032 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13033 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13034 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13035 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13036 appropriate server.
13037
13038 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13039
13040 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13041 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13042
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013043 See also: "option transparent"
13044
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013045unique-id-format <string>
13046 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13048 yes | yes | yes | no
13049 Arguments :
13050 <string> is a log-format string.
13051
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013052 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13053 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13054 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13055 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013056
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013057 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
13058 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
13059 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13060 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13061 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13062 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13063 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13064 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013065
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013066 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13067 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013068
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013069 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013070
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013071 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013072
13073 will generate:
13074
13075 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13076
13077 See also: "unique-id-header"
13078
13079unique-id-header <name>
13080 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13082 yes | yes | yes | no
13083 Arguments :
13084 <name> is the name of the header.
13085
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013086 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13087 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013088
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013089 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013090
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013091 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013092 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13093
13094 will generate:
13095
13096 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13097
13098 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013099
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013100use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013101 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013102 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13103 no | yes | yes | no
13104 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013105 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13106 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013107
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013108 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13109 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013110
13111 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13112 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13113 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013114 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013115 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013116 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13117 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013118
13119 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13120 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13121 assign the backend.
13122
13123 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13124 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13125 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13126 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13127 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13128 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13129
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013130 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013131 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013132 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13133 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13134 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13135
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013136 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13137 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13138 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13139 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13140 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13141 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13142 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13143 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13144 cannot be forced from the request.
13145
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013146 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013147 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13148 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13149
13150 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13151 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013152
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013153use-fcgi-app <name>
13154 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13155 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13156 no | no | yes | yes
13157 Arguments :
13158 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13159
13160 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013161
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013162use-server <server> if <condition>
13163use-server <server> unless <condition>
13164 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13165 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13166 no | no | yes | yes
13167 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013168 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13169 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013170
13171 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13172
13173 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13174 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13175 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13176
13177 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13178 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13179 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13180 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13181 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13182 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13183 matches will assign the server.
13184
13185 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13186 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13187 with the next rules until one matches.
13188
13189 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13190 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13191 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13192 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13193
13194 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13195 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13196 stripped.
13197
13198 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13199 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013200 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
13201 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
13202 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013203
13204 Example :
13205 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
13206 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
13207 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
13208 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013209 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013210 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013211 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013212 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13213 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13214
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013215 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13216 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13217 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13218 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013219 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013220 and we fall back to load balancing.
13221
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013222 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013223
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013224
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100132255. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013226--------------------------
13227
13228The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13229depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13230settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13231written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13232described in this section.
13233
13234
132355.1. Bind options
13236-----------------
13237
13238The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13239as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13240no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13241parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13242while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13243provided immediately after the setting name.
13244
13245The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13246
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013247accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13248 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13249 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13250 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13251 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13252 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13253 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13254 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13255 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13256 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013257 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13258 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13259 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013260
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013261accept-proxy
13262 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013263 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13264 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013265 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13266 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13267 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13268 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013269 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013270 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13271 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013272 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13273 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013274
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013275allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013276 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013277 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013278 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013279 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13280 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013281
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013282alpn <protocols>
13283 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13284 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13285 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013286 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013287 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013288 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13289 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13290 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13291 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13292 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13293 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13294 preference, like below :
13295
13296 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013297
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013298backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013299 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013300 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13301
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013302curves <curves>
13303 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13304 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13305 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13306 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13307 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13308 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13309
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013310ecdhe <named curve>
13311 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013312 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13313 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013314
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013315ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013316 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13317 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13318 client's certificate.
13319
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013320ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13321 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13322 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13323 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13324 error is ignored.
13325
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013326ca-sign-file <cafile>
13327 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13328 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13329 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13330 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13331 'generate-certificates' for details.
13332
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013333ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013334 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13335 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13336 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13337 'generate-certificates' for details.
13338
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013339ca-verify-file <cafile>
13340 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13341 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13342 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13343 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13344 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13345
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013346ciphers <ciphers>
13347 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13348 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013349 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013350 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013351 information and recommendations see e.g.
13352 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13353 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13354 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13355
13356ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13357 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13358 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13359 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13360 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013361 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13362 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013363
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013364crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013365 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13366 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13367 to verify client's certificate.
13368
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013369crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013370 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13371 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13372 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13373 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13374 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013375 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13376 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013377
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013378 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13379 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13380
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013381 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13382 are loaded.
13383
13384 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013385 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13386 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13387 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13388 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13389 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13390 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13391 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013392 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013393
13394 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13395 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13396 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13397 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013398 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13399 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013400
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013401 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013402
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013403 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013404 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013405 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13406 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013407 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13408 clients).
13409
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013410 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13411 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13412 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13413 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13414 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13415 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13416 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13417 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13418 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13419 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13420 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13421 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13422 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13423
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013424 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13425 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13426 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13427 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13428 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13429
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013430 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13431 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13432 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13433 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013434
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013435 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13436 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13437 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013438
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013439crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013440 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013441 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013442 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013443 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013444
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013445crt-list <file>
13446 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013447 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13448 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013449
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013450 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13451
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013452 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13453 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13454 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13455 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13456 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013457
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013458 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013459 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13460 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13461 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13462 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13463 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013464 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13465 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13466 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013467
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013468 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13469 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13470 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013471
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013472 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13473
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013474 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13475 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13476 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13477 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13478 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13479 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13480 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13481 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013482
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013483 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013484 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013485 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013486 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013487 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013488 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013489
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013490defer-accept
13491 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13492 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13493 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013494 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013495 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13496 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13497 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13498 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13499 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13500 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13501 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13502
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013503expose-fd listeners
13504 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13505 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013506 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13507 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013508 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013509
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013510force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013511 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013512 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013513 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013514 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013515
13516force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013517 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013518 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013519 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013520
13521force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013522 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013523 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013524 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013525
13526force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013527 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013528 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013529 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013530
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013531force-tlsv13
13532 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13533 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013534 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013535
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013536generate-certificates
13537 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13538 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13539 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13540 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13541 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13542 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13543 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13544 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13545 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13546 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13547 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13548
13549 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13550 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013551 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013552 certificate is used many times.
13553
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013554gid <gid>
13555 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13556 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13557 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13558 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13559 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13560
13561group <group>
13562 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13563 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13564 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13565 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13566 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13567
13568id <id>
13569 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13570 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13571 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13572 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13573
13574interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013575 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13576 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13577 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13578 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13579 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13580 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013581 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13582 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13583 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13584 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13585 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13586 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013587
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013588level <level>
13589 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13590 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13591 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013592 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013593 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13594 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13595 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013596 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013597 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013598 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013599 all counters).
13600
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013601severity-output <format>
13602 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13603 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13604 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13605 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13606 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13607 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13608 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13609 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13610 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13611 rfc5424 convention.
13612
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013613maxconn <maxconn>
13614 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13615 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13616 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13617 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13618 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13619 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13620 eat all memory.
13621
13622mode <mode>
13623 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13624 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13625 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13626 UNIX sockets.
13627
13628mss <maxseg>
13629 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13630 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13631 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13632 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13633 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13634 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13635 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13636 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13637 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13638 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13639 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13640
13641name <name>
13642 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13643 page.
13644
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013645namespace <name>
13646 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13647 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13648 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13649 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13650
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013651nice <nice>
13652 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13653 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13654 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13655 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13656 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13657 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13658 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13659 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13660 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13661 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13662 one for an RDP socket.
13663
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013664no-ca-names
13665 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13666 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013667 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013668
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013669no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013670 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013671 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013672 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013673 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013674 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13675 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013676
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013677no-tls-tickets
13678 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13679 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13680 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013681 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13682 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013683 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13684 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13685 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013686
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013687no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013688 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013689 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013690 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013691 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013692 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13693 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013694
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013695no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013696 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013697 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013698 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013699 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013700 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13701 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013702
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013703no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013704 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013705 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013706 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013707 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013708 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13709 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013710
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013711no-tlsv13
13712 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13713 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13714 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13715 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013716 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13717 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013718
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013719npn <protocols>
13720 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13721 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13722 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013723 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013724 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013725 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13726 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13727 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13728 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13729 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013730
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013731prefer-client-ciphers
13732 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13733 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13734 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013735 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13736 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13737 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013738
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013739process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013740 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013741 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013742 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013743 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13744 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13745 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13746 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013747 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013748 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13749 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13750 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13751 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13752 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013753
13754 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13755
13756 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13757 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13758 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13759 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13760 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13761 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13762 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13763 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013764
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013765proto <name>
13766 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13767 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13768 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013769 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13770 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13771
13772 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13773 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13774 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13775 also reported (flag=HTX).
13776
13777 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13778 a bind line :
13779
13780 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13781 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13782 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13783
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013784 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013785 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013786 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013787 h2" on the bind line.
13788
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013789ssl
13790 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013791 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013792 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13793 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013794 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13795 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013796
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013797ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13798 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013799 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13800 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13801 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013802 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13803
13804ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013805 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13806 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13807 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13808 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013809
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013810strict-sni
13811 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13812 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13813 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13814 See the "crt" option for more information.
13815
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013816tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013817 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013818 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13819 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013820 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013821 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13822 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13823 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13824 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13825 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13826 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13827 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13828
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013829tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013830 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013831 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13832 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13833 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13834 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13835 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13836 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13837 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013838 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13839 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13840 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013841
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013842tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13843 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013844 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13845 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13846 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13847 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13848 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13849 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13850 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13851 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13852 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13853 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013854 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13855 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13856
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013857transparent
13858 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13859 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13860 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13861 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13862 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13863 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13864 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13865 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13866 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13867 so check for support with your vendor.
13868
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013869v4v6
13870 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13871 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13872 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13873 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013874 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013875
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013876v6only
13877 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13878 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13879 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013880 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13881 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013882
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013883uid <uid>
13884 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13885 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13886 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13887 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13888 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13889
13890user <user>
13891 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13892 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13893 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13894 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13895 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13896
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013897verify [none|optional|required]
13898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13899 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13900 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13901 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13902 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013903 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13904 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13905 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13906 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013907
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200139085.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013909------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013910
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013911The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13912which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13913arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13914settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13915after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13916Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13917address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013918
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013919 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013920 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013921
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013922Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13923keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13924
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013925The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013926
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013927addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013928 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013929 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13930 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13931 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13932 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13933 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013934
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013935agent-check
13936 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013937 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013938 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13939 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13940 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013941
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013942 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013943 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013944 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13945 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13946 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013947
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013948 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13949 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13950 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13951 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13952 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013953
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013954 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013955 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013956
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013957 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13958 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13959 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013960
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013961 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13962 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13963 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013964
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013965 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013966 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13967 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13968 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13969 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013970 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013971 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013972
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013973 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13974 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013975
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013976 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13977 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13978 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13979 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13980 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13981 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13982 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13983 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13984 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013985
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013986 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13987 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013988 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13989 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13990 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013991 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013992
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013993 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013994 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013995
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013996agent-send <string>
13997 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13998 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13999 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14000 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14001 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14002
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014003agent-inter <delay>
14004 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14005 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14006
14007 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14008 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14009 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14010 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14011 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14012 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14013 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14014 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14015 of backends use the same servers.
14016
14017 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14018
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014019agent-addr <addr>
14020 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14021
14022 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
14023 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
14024 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14025 hostname, it will be resolved.
14026
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014027agent-port <port>
14028 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14029
14030 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14031
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014032allow-0rtt
14033 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014034 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14035 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014036
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014037alpn <protocols>
14038 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14039 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14040 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014041 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014042 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14043 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14044 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14045 now obsolete NPN extension.
14046 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14047 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14048
14049 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014051backup
14052 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14053 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14054 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14055 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014056 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14057 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014058
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014059ca-file <cafile>
14060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14061 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14062 server's certificate.
14063
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014064check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014065 This option enables health checks on a server:
14066 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14067 considered available.
14068 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14069 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14070 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14071 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14072 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14073 set.
14074 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14075 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14076 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14077 exchanges succeed.
14078
14079 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14080 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14081 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14082 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14083 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014084 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014085 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14086
14087 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14088 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14089
14090 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14091 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14092
14093 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14094 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14095 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14096 available.
14097
14098 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14099 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14100 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14101
14102 Example:
14103 # simple tcp check
14104 backend foo
14105 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14106 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14107 backend foo
14108 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14109 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14110 backend foo
14111 option tcp-check
14112 tcp-check connect
14113 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014114
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014115check-send-proxy
14116 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14117 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14118 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14119 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14120 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14121 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14122 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14123
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014124check-alpn <protocols>
14125 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14126 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14127 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14128
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014129check-proto <name>
14130 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14131 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14132 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014133 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14134 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14135
14136 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14137 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14138 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14139 also reported (flag=HTX).
14140
14141 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14142 directive on a server line:
14143
14144 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14145 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14146 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14147 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14148
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014149 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014150 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14151 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14152
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014153check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014154 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014155 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14156 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014157
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014158check-ssl
14159 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14160 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14161 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14162 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014163 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014164 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14165 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014166 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014167 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14168 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014169
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014170check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014171 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014172 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14173 for normal traffic.
14174
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014175ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014176 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14177 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14178 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014179 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14180 information and recommendations see e.g.
14181 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14182 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14183 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014184
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014185ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14186 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14187 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14188 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14189 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014190 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14191 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14192 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014193
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014194cookie <value>
14195 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14196 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14197 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14198 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14199 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14200 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14201 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14202
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014203crl-file <crlfile>
14204 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14205 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14206 to verify server's certificate.
14207
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014208crt <cert>
14209 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14210 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14211 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14212 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14213 certificate request.
14214
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014215disabled
14216 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14217 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14218 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14219 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14220 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014221 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014222
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014223enabled
14224 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14225 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14226 default value.
14227 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14228 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014229
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014230error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014231 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14232 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14233 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014234
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014235 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014236
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014237fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014238 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14239 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14240 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14241
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014242force-sslv3
14243 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14244 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014245 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014246 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014247
14248force-tlsv10
14249 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014250 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014251 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014252
14253force-tlsv11
14254 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014255 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014256 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014257
14258force-tlsv12
14259 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014260 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014261 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014262
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014263force-tlsv13
14264 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14265 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014266 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014268id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014269 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14270 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14271 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014272
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014273init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14274 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14275 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014276 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014277 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14278 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14279 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14280 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14281 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14282 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14283 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14284 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14285 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014286 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014287 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14288 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14289 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14290 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14291 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14292 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014293 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014294
14295 Example:
14296 defaults
14297 # never fail on address resolution
14298 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014300inter <delay>
14301fastinter <delay>
14302downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014303 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14304 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14305 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14306 between checks depending on the server state :
14307
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014308 Server state | Interval used
14309 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14310 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14311 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14312 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14313 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14314 or yet unchecked. |
14315 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14316 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14317 | "inter" otherwise.
14318 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014319
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014320 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14321 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14322 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14323 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014324 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14325 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14326 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14327 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14328 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014329
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014330log-proto <logproto>
14331 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14332 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14333 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14334 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14335
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014336maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014337 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14338 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014339 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14340 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014341 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14342 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14343 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14344 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14345
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014346 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14347 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14348 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14349 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14350 than 50 concurrent requests.
14351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014352maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014353 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14354 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14355 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14356 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014357 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14358 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14359 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14360 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14361 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14362 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14363 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014364
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014365max-reuse <count>
14366 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14367 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14368 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14369 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14370 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14371 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14372 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14373 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014375minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014376 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14377 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14378 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14379 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14380 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14381 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014382 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014383 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014384
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014385namespace <name>
14386 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14387 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14388 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14389 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14390
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014391no-agent-check
14392 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14393 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14394 default value.
14395 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14396 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14397
14398no-backup
14399 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14400 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14401 default value.
14402 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14403 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14404
14405no-check
14406 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14407 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14408 default value.
14409 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14410 "default-server" "check" setting.
14411
14412no-check-ssl
14413 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14414 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14415 default value.
14416 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14417 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14418
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014419no-send-proxy
14420 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14421 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14422 default value.
14423 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14424 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14425
14426no-send-proxy-v2
14427 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14428 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14429 default value.
14430 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14431 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14432
14433no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14434 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14435 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14436 default value.
14437 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14438 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14439
14440no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14441 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14442 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14443 default value.
14444 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14445 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14446
14447no-ssl
14448 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14449 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14450 default value.
14451 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14452 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14453
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014454 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14455 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14456 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14457
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014458no-ssl-reuse
14459 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14460 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14461 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14462 and for paranoid users.
14463
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014464no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014465 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14466 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014467 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014468
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014469 Supported in default-server: No
14470
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014471no-tls-tickets
14472 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14473 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14474 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014475 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14476 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014477 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14478 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14479 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014480 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014481
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014482no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014483 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014484 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14485 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014486 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14487 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014488 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014489
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014490 Supported in default-server: No
14491
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014492no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014493 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014494 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14495 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014496 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14497 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014498 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014499
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014500 Supported in default-server: No
14501
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014502no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014503 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014504 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14505 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014506 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14507 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014508 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014509
14510 Supported in default-server: No
14511
14512no-tlsv13
14513 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14514 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14515 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14516 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14517 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014518 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014519
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014520 Supported in default-server: No
14521
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014522no-verifyhost
14523 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14524 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14525 default value.
14526 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14527 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014528
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014529no-tfo
14530 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14531 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14532 default value.
14533 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14534 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14535
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014536non-stick
14537 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14538 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14539 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14540
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014541npn <protocols>
14542 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14543 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14544 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014545 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014546 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14547 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14548 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14549
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014550observe <mode>
14551 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14552 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14553 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14554 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14555 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14556 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014557 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014558
14559 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14560
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014561on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014562 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14563 Currently, four modes are available:
14564 - fastinter: force fastinter
14565 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14566 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14567 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14568 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14569
14570 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14571
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014572on-marked-down <action>
14573 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14574 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014575 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14576 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14577 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14578 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14579 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14580 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14581 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14582 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014583
14584 Actions are disabled by default
14585
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014586on-marked-up <action>
14587 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14588 Currently one action is available:
14589 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14590 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14591 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14592 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014593 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14594 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014595 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14596 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14597
14598 Actions are disabled by default
14599
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014600pool-low-conn <max>
14601 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14602 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14603 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14604 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14605 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14606 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14607 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14608 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14609 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14610 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014611 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14612 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14613 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14614 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014615
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014616pool-max-conn <max>
14617 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14618 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14619 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14620 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14621 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14622 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14623
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014624pool-purge-delay <delay>
14625 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014626 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014627 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014628
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014629port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014630 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014631 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14632 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14633 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14634 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14635 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014636
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014637proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014638 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14639 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14640 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014641 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14642 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14643
14644 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14645 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14646 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14647 also reported (flag=HTX).
14648
14649 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14650 a server line :
14651
14652 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14653 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14654 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14655 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14656
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014657 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014658 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14659
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014660redir <prefix>
14661 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14662 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14663 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14664 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14665 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14666 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14667 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14668 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014669 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014670 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014671 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14672 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14673 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14674 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14675
14676 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14677
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014678rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014679 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14680 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14681 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14682
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014683resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14684 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14685 server.
14686
14687 Available options:
14688
14689 * allow-dup-ip
14690 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14691 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14692 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14693 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14694 For such case, simply enable this option.
14695 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14696
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014697 * ignore-weight
14698 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14699 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14700 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14701
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014702 * prevent-dup-ip
14703 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14704 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14705 same fqdn.
14706 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14707
14708 Example:
14709 backend b_myapp
14710 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14711 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14712 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14713
14714 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14715 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14716 it
14717 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14718 different address
14719
14720 Default value: not set
14721
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014722resolve-prefer <family>
14723 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14724 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14725 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14726 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14727
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014728 Default value: ipv6
14729
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014730 Example:
14731
14732 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014733
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014734resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014735 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014736 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014737 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014738 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14739 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014740 configured network, another address is selected.
14741
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014742 Example:
14743
14744 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014745
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014746resolvers <id>
14747 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14748 hostname.
14749
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014750 Example:
14751
14752 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014753
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014754 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014755
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014756send-proxy
14757 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14758 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14759 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14760 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014761 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14762 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14763 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14764 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14765 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14766 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14767 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14768 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14769 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14770 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014771 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14772 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014773
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014774send-proxy-v2
14775 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14776 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14777 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14778 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014779 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14780 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14781 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14782 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014783
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014784proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014785 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14786 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14787
14788 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14789 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14790 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14791 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14792 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14793 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14794 connection is supported).
14795 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14796 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14797 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14798 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14799 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14800 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14801 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014802
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014803send-proxy-v2-ssl
14804 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14805 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14806 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14807 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14808 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14809 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14810 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014811 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14812 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014813
14814send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14815 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14816 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14817 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14818 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14819 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14820 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14821 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14822 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014823 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14824 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014825
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014826slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014827 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14828 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14829 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14830 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14831 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14832 parameters :
14833
14834 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14835 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14836
14837 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14838 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14839 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14840 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14841
14842 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14843 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14844 seen as failed.
14845
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014846sni <expression>
14847 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14848 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14849 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14850 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014851 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14852 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014853 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014854 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14855 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014856
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014857source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014858source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014859source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014860 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14861 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14862 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14863 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14864
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014865 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14866 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14867 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14868 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14869 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14870 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14871 server.
14872
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014873 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14874 specifying the source address without port(s).
14875
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014876ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014877 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14878 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14879 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14880 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14881 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14882 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014883 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14884 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014885
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014886ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14887 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14888 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14889 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14890
14891ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14892 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14893 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14894 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14895
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014896ssl-reuse
14897 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14898 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14899 default value.
14900 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14901 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14902
14903stick
14904 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14905 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14906 default value.
14907 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14908 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014909
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014910socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014911 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014912 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14913 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14914
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014915tcp-ut <delay>
14916 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14917 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14918 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014919 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014920 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14921 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14922 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14923 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14924 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14925 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14926 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14927 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14928 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14929
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014930tfo
14931 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14932 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14933 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14934 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14935 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014936 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014937
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014938track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014939 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14940 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14941 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14942 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014943 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14944
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014945tls-tickets
14946 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14947 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14948 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014949 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14950 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14951 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014952 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014953 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014954
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014955verify [none|required]
14956 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014957 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014958 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14959 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014960 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014961 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14962 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14963 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14964 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14965 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14966 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14967 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14968 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014969
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014970verifyhost <hostname>
14971 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014972 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14973 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14974 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14975 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14976 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14977 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14978 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14979 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014980
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014981weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014982 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14983 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14984 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014985 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14986 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14987 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14988 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14989 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14990 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014991
14992
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200149935.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14994-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014995
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014996HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14997using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014998configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014999This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15000can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15001workload.
15002This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15003resolution at run time.
15004Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15005carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15006
15007
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150085.3.1. Global overview
15009----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015010
15011As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15012different steps of the process life:
15013
15014 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15015 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15016 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15017
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015018 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15019 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015020
15021A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15022 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15023 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15024 resolution to know this new IP.
15025
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015026When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015027HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015028SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15029from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
15030will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
15031will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015032
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015033A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015034 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015035 first valid response.
15036
15037 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15038 servers return an error.
15039
15040
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200150415.3.2. The resolvers section
15042----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015043
15044This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015045HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15046contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015047
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015048When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15049uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15050is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15051answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15052
15053When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015054used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015055
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015056 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15057 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15058 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015059
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015060 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15061 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015062
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015063 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
15064 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15065 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015066
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015067For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15068following scenarios are possible:
15069
15070 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15071 ignored
15072
15073 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15074 applied
15075
15076 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15077 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15078
15079 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15080 retries the query with a new type
15081
15082 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15083 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015084
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015085As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
15086a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015087<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015088
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015089
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015090resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015091 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015092
15093A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15094
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015095accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015096 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015097 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015098 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15099 by RFC 6891)
15100
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015101 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15102 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15103 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15104 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15105 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15106 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015107
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015108nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15109 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15110 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15111 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15112 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15113 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15114 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15115 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15116 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15117 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015118 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15119
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015120parse-resolv-conf
15121 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15122 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15123 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15124
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015125hold <status> <period>
15126 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15127 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015128 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015129 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015130 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15131 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15132 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15133
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015134 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015135
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015136resolve_retries <nb>
15137 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15138 giving up.
15139 Default value: 3
15140
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015141 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15142 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15143 type.
15144
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015145timeout <event> <time>
15146 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15147 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15148 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015149 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15150 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015151 Default value: 1s
15152 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015153 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015154 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015155 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15156 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15157
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015158 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015159
15160 resolvers mydns
15161 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15162 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015163 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015164 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015165 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015166 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015167 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015168 hold other 30s
15169 hold refused 30s
15170 hold nx 30s
15171 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015172 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015173 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015174
15175
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200151766. Cache
15177---------
15178
15179HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15180(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15181RAM.
15182
15183The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15184this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15185
15186If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15187independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15188when we try to allocate a new one.
15189
15190The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15191
15192It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15193"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15194for more details.
15195
15196When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15197replaced by "<CACHE>".
15198
15199
152006.1. Limitation
15201----------------
15202
15203The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15204
15205- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015206- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15207 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15208 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015209- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15210- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015211- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15212 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15213 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015214- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15215 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015216- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15217 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15218 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015219
15220- If the request is not a GET
15221- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15222- If the request contains an Authorization header
15223
15224
152256.2. Setup
15226-----------
15227
15228To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15229the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15230
15231
152326.2.1. Cache section
15233---------------------
15234
15235cache <name>
15236 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15237 size of cache is mandatory.
15238
15239total-max-size <megabytes>
15240 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15241 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15242
15243max-object-size <bytes>
15244 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15245 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15246 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15247
15248max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015249 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015250 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15251 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15252 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15253 default.
15254
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015255process-vary <on/off>
15256 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015257 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15258 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15259 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015260 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015261
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015262max-secondary-entries <number>
15263 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15264 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15265 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15266
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015267
152686.2.2. Proxy section
15269---------------------
15270
15271http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15272 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15273 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15274 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15275 after this one.
15276
15277http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15278 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15279 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15280 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15281 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15282
15283
15284Example:
15285
15286 backend bck1
15287 mode http
15288
15289 http-request cache-use foobar
15290 http-response cache-store foobar
15291 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15292
15293 cache foobar
15294 total-max-size 4
15295 max-age 240
15296
15297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200152987. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15299----------------------------------
15300
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015301HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015302client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15303The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15304these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15305but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15306data called patterns.
15307
15308
153097.1. ACL basics
15310---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015311
15312The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15313content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15314from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15315simple :
15316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015317 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015318 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015319 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15320 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015321
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015322The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15323adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015324
15325In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015327 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015328
15329This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15330Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15331and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015332an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15333conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15334as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15335are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015336
15337ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15338'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15339which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15340
15341There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15342performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15343
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015344The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15345specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15346this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015347methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15348ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015349
15350Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15351 - boolean
15352 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15353 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15354 - string
15355 - data block
15356
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015357Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15358converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15359would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15360The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15361which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15362
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015363Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15364keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15365fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15366which are summarized in the table below :
15367
15368 +---------------------+-----------------+
15369 | Sample or converter | Default |
15370 | output type | matching method |
15371 +---------------------+-----------------+
15372 | boolean | bool |
15373 +---------------------+-----------------+
15374 | integer | int |
15375 +---------------------+-----------------+
15376 | ip | ip |
15377 +---------------------+-----------------+
15378 | string | str |
15379 +---------------------+-----------------+
15380 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15381 +---------------------+-----------------+
15382
15383Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15384matching method, see below.
15385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015386The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15387 - boolean
15388 - integer or integer range
15389 - IP address / network
15390 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15391 - regular expression
15392 - hex block
15393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015394The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15395
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015396 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15397 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015398 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015399 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015400 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015401 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015402 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015404The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15405read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15406if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15407lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15408will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15409beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15410a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15411lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15412exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15413
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015414The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15415parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15416ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15417a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15418check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15419
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015420The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15421socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15422file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015424Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15425loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15426
15427 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15428
15429In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15430the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15431case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15432as well.
15433
15434The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15435sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15436do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15437methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15438is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015439obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015440followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15441default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15442that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15443string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15444
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015445The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15446By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15447string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15448resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15449server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015450waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015451flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15452function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015454There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15455sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15456be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015457
15458 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15459 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015460 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15461 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15462 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15463 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015464
15465 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15466 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015467 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015468
15469 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015470 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015471
15472 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015473 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015474
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015475 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015476 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15477
15478 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15479 binary or string samples.
15480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015481 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15482 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015484 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15485 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15486 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015488 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15489 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015491 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15492 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015493
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015494 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15495 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015496
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015497 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15498 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015499 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015501 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15502 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15503 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015504
15505For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15506request, it is possible to do :
15507
15508 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15509
15510In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15511buffer, one would use the following acl :
15512
15513 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15514
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015515On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15516possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15517
15518 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15519
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15521criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15522method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15523to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15524criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15525the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015526
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015527If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015528the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15529For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015530
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015531 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15532 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15533 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15534 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015535
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015536
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015537The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15538types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15539combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15540brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15541default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015542
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543 +-------------------------------------------------+
15544 | Input sample type |
15545 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015546 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15548 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15549 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015550 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015551 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015552 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015553 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015554 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015555 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015556 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015557 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015558 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015559 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015560 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015561 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015562 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015563 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015564 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015565 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015566 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015567 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015568 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015569 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015570 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15572 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15573 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015574
15575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155767.1.1. Matching booleans
15577------------------------
15578
15579In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15580Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15581When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15582that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15583
15584Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15585return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15586"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15587
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200155897.1.2. Matching integers
15590------------------------
15591
15592Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15593enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15594to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15595
15596Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15597matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15598lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015599
15600For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15601unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15602representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15603
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015604As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15605two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15606instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15607ranges and operators.
15608
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015609For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015610operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15611Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15612of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015613
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015614Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015615
15616 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15617 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15618 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15619 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15620 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15621
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015622For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015623
15624 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15625
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015626This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15627
15628 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15629
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156317.1.3. Matching strings
15632-----------------------
15633
15634String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15635different forms :
15636
15637 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015638 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015639
15640 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015641 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015642
15643 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15644 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15645
15646 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15647 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15648
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015649 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015650 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15651 matches.
15652
15653 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15654 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15655 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015656
15657String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15658exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15659characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15660string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15661to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015662before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015663
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015664Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15665(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15666Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15667
15668Example:
15669 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15670 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15671
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15674---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015675
15676Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15677they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15678possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15679passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15680the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015681the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15682match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015683
15684
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156857.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15686-------------------------------------
15687
15688It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15689not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15690a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15691to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15692digits may be used upper or lower case.
15693
15694Example :
15695 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15696 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15697
15698
156997.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15700---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015701
15702IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15703netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15704within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015705host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015706difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15707at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15708does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15709parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015710
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015711The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15712abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15713
15714 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15715 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15716 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15717 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15718 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15719 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15720 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15721 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15722
15723Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15724192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15725
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015726IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15727Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15728trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15729IPv6 patterns.
15730
15731HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15732following situations :
15733 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15734 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15735 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15736 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15737 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15738 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15739 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15740 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15741 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15742 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015744
157457.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15746----------------------------------
15747
15748Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15749combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15750
15751 - AND (implicit)
15752 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15753 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015755A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015756
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015757 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015759Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15760indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015762For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15763"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15764requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15765is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15766
15767 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015768 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15769 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15770 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015771
15772To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15773and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15774
15775 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15776 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15777 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15778 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15779
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015780 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015781 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15782 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15783 use_backend www if host_www
15784
15785It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15786expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15787be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15788the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15789
15790 The following rule :
15791
15792 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015793 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015794
15795 Can also be written that way :
15796
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015797 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015798
15799It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15800to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15801simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15802sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15803good use is the following :
15804
15805 With named ACLs :
15806
15807 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15808 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15809 monitor fail if site_dead
15810
15811 With anonymous ACLs :
15812
15813 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15814
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015815See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15816keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817
15818
158197.3. Fetching samples
15820---------------------
15821
15822Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15823against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15824sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15825ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15826of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15827available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15828
15829This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15830Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15831compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15832deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15833
15834The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15835matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15836method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15837indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15838
15839As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15840when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15841mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15842the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15843ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15844
15845Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15846multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15847when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015848incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15849are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15851all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15852
15853Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15854 - name
15855 - name(arg1)
15856 - name(arg1,arg2)
15857
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015858
158597.3.1. Converters
15860-----------------
15861
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015862Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15863of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15864is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15865was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015866has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015867unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15868
15869These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15870sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15871the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015872support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015873
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015874A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15875support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15876supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15877(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15878bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015880The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015881
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001588251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15883 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15884 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15885 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15886 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15887 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15888
15889 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015890 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15891 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015892 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15893 frontend http-in
15894 bind *:8081
15895 default_backend servers
15896 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15897 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15898
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015899add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015900 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015901 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015902 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15903 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015904 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015905 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15906 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15907 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15908 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015909 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015910 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015911
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015912aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15913 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15914 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15915 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15916 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15917 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15918 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15919
15920 Example:
15921 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15922 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15923
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015924and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015925 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015926 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015927 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15928 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015929 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015930 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15931 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15932 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15933 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015934 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015935 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015936
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015937b64dec
15938 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15939 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015940 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15941 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015942
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015943base64
15944 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015945 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015946 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15947 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015948
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015949bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015950 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015951 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015952 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015953 presence of a flag).
15954
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015955bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15956 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15957 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015958 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015959
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015960concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15961 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15962 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15963 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15964 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15965 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15966 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15967 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15968 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15969 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15970 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015971 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015972 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015973 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15974 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015975
15976 Example:
15977 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15978 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15979 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015980 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015981 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15982
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015983cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015984 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15985 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015986
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015987crc32([<avalanche>])
15988 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15989 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15990 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15991 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15992 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15993 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15994 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15995 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15996 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15997 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015998 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15999
16000crc32c([<avalanche>])
16001 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16002 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16003 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16004 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16005 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16006 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16007 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16008 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016009
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016010cut_crlf
16011 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16012 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16013 updated.
16014
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016015da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016016 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16017 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16018 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16019 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016020 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016021 configuration language.
16022
16023 Example:
16024 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016025 bind *:8881
16026 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016027 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016028
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016029debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16030 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16031 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16032 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16033 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16034 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16035 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16036 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16037 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16038 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16039 printable sample types.
16040
16041 Example:
16042 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016043
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016044digest(<algorithm>)
16045 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16046 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16047
16048 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16049 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16050
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016051div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016052 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16053 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016054 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016055 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16056 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016057 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016058 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16059 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16060 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16061 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016062 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016063 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016064
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016065djb2([<avalanche>])
16066 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16067 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16068 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16069 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16070 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16071 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16072 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016073 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16074 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016075
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016076even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016077 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016078 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16079
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016080field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16081 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16082 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16083 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16084 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16085 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16086 fields.
16087
16088 Example :
16089 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16090 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16091 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16092 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16093 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016094
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016095fix_is_valid
16096 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16097 Information eXchange):
16098
16099 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16100 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016101 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016102 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016103 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016104 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16105 checksum
16106
16107 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16108 the server can be parsed.
16109
16110 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16111 message, false if not.
16112
16113 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16114
16115 Example:
16116 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16117 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16118
16119fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16120 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16121 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16122 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16123 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016124 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016125 added.
16126
16127 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16128 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16129 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16130 fix_is_valid converter.
16131
16132 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16133
16134 Example:
16135 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16136 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16137 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16138 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16139 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16140
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016141hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016142 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016143 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016144 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016145 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016146
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016147hex2i
16148 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016149 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016150
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016151htonl
16152 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16153 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16154 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16155 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16156
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016157hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016158 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16159 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16160 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16161 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16162
16163 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16164 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16165
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016166http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016167 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16168 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016169 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16170 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16171 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16172 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16173 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16174 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16175 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16176 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016177
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016178iif(<true>,<false>)
16179 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16180 string otherwise.
16181
16182 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016183 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016184
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016185in_table(<table>)
16186 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16187 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16188 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016189 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016190 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16191
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016192ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016193 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016194 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016195 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16196 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16197 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16198 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16199 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016200
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016201json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016202 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016203 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016204 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016205 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16206 of errors:
16207 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16208 bytes, ...)
16209 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16210 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16211
16212 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16213 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16214 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16215 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16216 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16217 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016218 - "ascii" : never fails;
16219 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16220 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016221 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016222 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016223 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16224 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16225
16226 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016227 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016228
16229 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016230 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016231 capture request header user-agent len 150
16232 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016233
16234 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16235 GET / HTTP/1.0
16236 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16237
16238 Output log:
16239 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16240
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016241json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16242 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16243 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16244 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16245 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16246
16247 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16248 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16249
16250 Example:
16251 # get a integer value from the request body
16252 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16253 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16254
16255 # get a key with '.' in the name
16256 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16257 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16258
16259 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16260 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16261
16262 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16263 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16264
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016265language(<value>[,<default>])
16266 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16267 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16268 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16269 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16270 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16271 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16272 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16273 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16274 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016275 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016276 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16277 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016278
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016279 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016280
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016281 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16282 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016283
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016284 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16285 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16286 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16287 use_backend spanish if es
16288 use_backend french if fr
16289 use_backend english if en
16290 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016291
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016292length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016293 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16294 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16295 type. The result is of type integer.
16296
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016297lower
16298 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16299 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16300 type. The result is of type string.
16301
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016302ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16303 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16304 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16305 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16306 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16307 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16308 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16309
16310 Example :
16311
16312 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016313 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016314 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16315
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016316ltrim(<chars>)
16317 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16318 representation of the input sample.
16319
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016320map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16321map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16322map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16323 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16324 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16325 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16326 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16327 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16328 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16329 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16330 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016331
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016332 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16333 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16334 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016335
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016336 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016337 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016338
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016339 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16340 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16341 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16342 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016343 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16344 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016345 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16346 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16347 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16348 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16349 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16350 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16351 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16352 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016353 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16354 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16355 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016356 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16357 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16358 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16359 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16360 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016361
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016362 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16363 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16364 the corresponding match text.
16365
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016366 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16367 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16368 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16369 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16370 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016371
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016372 Example :
16373
16374 # this is a comment and is ignored
16375 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16376 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16377 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16378 | | | `---------- value
16379 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16380 | `---------------------------- key
16381 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16382
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016383mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016384 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16385 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016386 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016387 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016388 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016389 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16390 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16391 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16392 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016393 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016394 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016395
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016396mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016397 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16398 <packettype>.
16399 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16400 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16401 from.
16402 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16403 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16404 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16405
16406 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16407 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16408 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16409 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16410
16411 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16412 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16413 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16414 packets only):
16415 17: Session Expiry Interval
16416 33: Receive Maximum
16417 39: Maximum Packet Size
16418 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16419 25: Request Response Information
16420 23: Request Problem Information
16421 21: Authentication Method
16422 22: Authentication Data
16423 18: Will Delay Interval
16424 1: Payload Format Indicator
16425 2: Message Expiry Interval
16426 3: Content Type
16427 8: Response Topic
16428 9: Correlation Data
16429 Not supported yet:
16430 38: User Property
16431
16432 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16433 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16434 packets only):
16435 17: Session Expiry Interval
16436 33: Receive Maximum
16437 36: Maximum QoS
16438 37: Retain Available
16439 39: Maximum Packet Size
16440 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16441 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16442 31: Reason String
16443 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16444 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16445 42: Shared Subscription Available
16446 19: Server Keep Alive
16447 26: Response Information
16448 28: Server Reference
16449 21: Authentication Method
16450 22: Authentication Data
16451 Not supported yet:
16452 38: User Property
16453
16454 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16455 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16456 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16457 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16458
16459 Example:
16460
16461 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16462 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16463 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16464 if data_in_buffer
16465 # do the same as above
16466 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16467 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16468 if data_in_buffer
16469
16470mqtt_is_valid
16471 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16472
16473 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16474 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16475 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16476 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16477
16478 Example:
16479
16480 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16481 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16482
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016483mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016484 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016485 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16486 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016487 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016488 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016489 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016490 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16491 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16492 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16493 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016494 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016495 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016496
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016497nbsrv
16498 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16499 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16500 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16501 map lookup.
16502
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016503neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016504 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16505 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16506 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16507 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016508
16509not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016510 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016511 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016512 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016513 absence of a flag).
16514
16515odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016516 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016517 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16518
16519or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016520 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016521 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016522 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16523 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016524 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016525 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16526 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16527 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16528 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016529 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016530 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016531
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016532protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16533 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16534 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16535 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16536 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16537 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16538 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16539 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16540 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16541 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16542 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16543 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16544
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016545regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016546 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16547 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16548 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16549 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16550 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16551 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16552 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16553 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16554 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016555 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16556 of characters with other ones.
16557
16558 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16559 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16560 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16561 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16562 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16563 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016564
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016565 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016566
16567 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16568 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16569 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016570 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016571
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016572 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16573 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16574
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016575 # capture groups and backreferences
16576 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016577 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016578 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16579
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016580capture-req(<id>)
16581 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16582 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16583
16584 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016585 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16586 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016587
16588capture-res(<id>)
16589 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16590 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16591
16592 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016593 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16594 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016595
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016596rtrim(<chars>)
16597 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16598 of the input sample.
16599
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016600sdbm([<avalanche>])
16601 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16602 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16603 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16604 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16605 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16606 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16607 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016608 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16609 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016610
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016611secure_memcmp(<var>)
16612 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16613 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16614 match.
16615
16616 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16617 performed in constant time.
16618
16619 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16620 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16621
16622 Example :
16623
16624 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16625 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16626 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16627 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16628
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016629set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016630 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16631 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16632 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016633 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016634 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16635 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016636 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016637 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16638 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016639 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016640 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016641
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016642sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016643 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016644 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16645
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016646sha2([<bits>])
16647 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16648 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16649
16650 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16651 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16652
16653 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16654 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16655
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016656srv_queue
16657 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16658 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16659 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16660 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16661 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16662
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016663strcmp(<var>)
16664 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16665 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16666 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16667 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16668 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16669 shorter).
16670
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016671 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16672 strings in constant time.
16673
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016674 Example :
16675
16676 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16677 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16678 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16679
16680
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016681sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016682 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16683 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016684 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016685 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16686 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016687 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016688 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16689 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016690 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016691 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16692 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016693 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016694 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016695
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016696table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16697 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16698 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16699 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16700 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16701 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16702 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16703
16704
16705table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16706 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16707 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16708 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16709 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16710 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16711 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16712
16713table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16714 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16715 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016716 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016717 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16718 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16719
16720table_conn_cur(<table>)
16721 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16722 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16723 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16724 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16725 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16726
16727table_conn_rate(<table>)
16728 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16729 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16730 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16731 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16732 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16733
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016734table_gpt0(<table>)
16735 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16736 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16737 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16738 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16739 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16740
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016741table_gpc0(<table>)
16742 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16743 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16744 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16745 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16746 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16747
16748table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16749 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16750 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16751 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16752 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16753 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16754 sample fetch keyword.
16755
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016756table_gpc1(<table>)
16757 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16758 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16759 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16760 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16761 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16762
16763table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16764 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16765 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16766 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16767 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16768 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16769 sample fetch keyword.
16770
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016771table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16772 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16773 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016774 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016775 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16776 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16777
16778table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16779 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16780 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16781 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16782 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16783 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16784 keyword.
16785
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016786table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16787 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16788 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16789 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16790 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16791 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16792
16793table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16794 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16795 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16796 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16797 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16798 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16799 keyword.
16800
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016801table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16802 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16803 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016804 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016805 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16806 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16807
16808table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16809 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16810 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16811 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16812 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16813 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16814 keyword.
16815
16816table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16817 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16818 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016819 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016820 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16821 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16822 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16823 keyword.
16824
16825table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16826 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16827 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016828 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016829 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16830 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16831 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16832 keyword.
16833
16834table_server_id(<table>)
16835 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16836 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16837 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16838 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16839 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16840 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16841
16842table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16843 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16844 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016845 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016846 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16847 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16848 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16849 keyword.
16850
16851table_sess_rate(<table>)
16852 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16853 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16854 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16855 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16856 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16857 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16858 keyword.
16859
16860table_trackers(<table>)
16861 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16862 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16863 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16864 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16865 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16866 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16867 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16868 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16869 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16870 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16871
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016872ub64dec
16873 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16874 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16875 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16876
16877 Example:
16878 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16879 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16880
16881ub64enc
16882 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16883
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016884upper
16885 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16886 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16887 type. The result is of type string.
16888
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016889url_dec([<in_form>])
16890 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16891 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16892 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16893 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16894 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16895 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016896
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016897url_enc([<enc_type>])
16898 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16899 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16900 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16901 optional argument is here for future changes.
16902
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016903ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016904 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016905 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16906 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16907 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016908 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16909 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16910 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16911 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016912 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016913 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16914 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016915
16916 Example:
16917 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16918 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16919
16920 message Point {
16921 int32 latitude = 1;
16922 int32 longitude = 2;
16923 }
16924
16925 message PPoint {
16926 Point point = 59;
16927 }
16928
16929 message Rectangle {
16930 // One corner of the rectangle.
16931 PPoint lo = 48;
16932 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16933 PPoint hi = 49;
16934 }
16935
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016936 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16937 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16938 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016939
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016940 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16941 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016942 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016943 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16944
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016945 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016946
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016947 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016948
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016949 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16950 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16951 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016952
16953 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16954 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16955 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16956
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016957 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16958 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16959 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016960
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016961
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016962unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016963 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16964 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16965 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16966 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16967 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16968 response),
16969 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16970 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16971 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16972 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16973
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016974utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16975 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16976 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16977 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16978 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16979 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16980 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16981
16982 Example :
16983
16984 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016985 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016986 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16987
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016988word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16989 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16990 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16991 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016992 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016993 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16994 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16995
16996 Example :
16997 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16998 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16999 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17000 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17001 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017002 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017003
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017004wt6([<avalanche>])
17005 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17006 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17007 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17008 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17009 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17010 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17011 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017012 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17013 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017014
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017015xor(<value>)
17016 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017017 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017018 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017019 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017020 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017021 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17022 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017023 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017024 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17025 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017026 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017027 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017028
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017029xxh3([<seed>])
17030 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17031 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17032 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17033 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17034 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17035 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17036 considered as cryptographically secure.
17037
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017038xxh32([<seed>])
17039 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17040 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17041 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17042 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17043 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17044 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17045 as cryptographically secure.
17046
17047xxh64([<seed>])
17048 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17049 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17050 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17051 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17052 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17053 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17054 as cryptographically secure.
17055
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017056
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200170577.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017058--------------------------------------------
17059
17060A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17061not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17062"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17063The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17064
17065always_false : boolean
17066 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17067 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17068
17069always_true : boolean
17070 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17071 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17072
17073avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017074 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017075 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17076 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17077 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17078 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17079 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17080 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17081 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17082 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17083 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17084 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17085 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17086 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17087 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017088
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017089be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017090 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17091 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17092 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17093 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017094 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17095
17096be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17097 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17098 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17099 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17100 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17101 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017102 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17103 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017104
17105 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17106 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17107 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017109be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17110 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17111 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17112 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017113 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017114 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17115 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017116
17117 Example :
17118 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17119 backend dynamic
17120 mode http
17121 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17122 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017123
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017124bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017125 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17126 of the string.
17127
17128bool(<bool>) : bool
17129 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17130 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017132connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17133 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017134 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017135 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17136 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017137
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017138 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017139 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017140 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17141
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017142 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17143 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017144
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017145 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017146 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017147 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017148 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017149 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017150 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017151 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017152
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017153 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17154 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017155 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017156 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017157
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017158cpu_calls : integer
17159 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17160 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17161 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17162 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17163 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17164 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17165
17166cpu_ns_avg : integer
17167 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17168 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17169 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17170 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17171 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17172 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17173 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17174 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17175 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17176 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17177 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17178
17179cpu_ns_tot : integer
17180 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17181 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17182 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17183 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17184 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17185 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17186 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17187 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17188 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17189 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17190 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17191 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17192 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17193
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017194date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017195 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017196
17197 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17198 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17199 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017200 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17201
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017202 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17203 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17204 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17205 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17206 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17207
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017208 Example :
17209
17210 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17211 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017212
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017213 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17214 # millisecond granularity
17215 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17216
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017217date_us : integer
17218 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17219 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17220 from the same timeval structure.
17221
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017222distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17223 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17224 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17225 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17226 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
17227 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
17228 list of supported tokens.
17229
17230distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17231 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17232 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17233 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17234 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
17235 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
17236 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17237 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17238 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17239 supported tokens.
17240
17241 Example :
17242 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17243 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17244 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17245 # send large files to the big farm
17246 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17247
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017248env(<name>) : string
17249 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17250 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17251 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17252 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17253 certain way.
17254
17255 Examples :
17256 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17257 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17258
17259 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17260 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017262fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17263 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017264 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17265 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017266 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17267 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017268 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017269 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17270 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017271
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017272fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17273 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17274 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17275 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17276
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017277fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17278 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17279 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17280 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17281 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17282 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17283 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17284 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17285 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017286
17287 Example :
17288 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17289 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17290 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17291 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17292 frontend mail
17293 bind :25
17294 mode tcp
17295 maxconn 100
17296 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17297 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17298 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17299 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017300
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017301hostname : string
17302 Returns the system hostname.
17303
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017304int(<integer>) : signed integer
17305 Returns a signed integer.
17306
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017307ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17308 Returns an ipv4.
17309
17310ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17311 Returns an ipv6.
17312
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017313lat_ns_avg : integer
17314 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17315 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17316 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17317 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17318 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17319 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17320 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17321 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17322 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017323 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17324 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17325 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17326 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17327 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17328 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017329
17330lat_ns_tot : integer
17331 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17332 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17333 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17334 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17335 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17336 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17337 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17338 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17339 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017340 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17341 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17342 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17343 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17344 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017345 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17346 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17347 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17348 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17349 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17350 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17351
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017352meth(<method>) : method
17353 Returns a method.
17354
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017355nbproc : integer
17356 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17357 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17358 and debugging purposes.
17359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017360nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17361 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17362 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17363 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017364 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17365 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17366 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017367
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017368prio_class : integer
17369 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17370 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17371 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17372
17373prio_offset : integer
17374 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17375 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17376 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17377 set-priority-offset".
17378
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017379proc : integer
17380 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17381 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17382 debugging purposes.
17383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017384queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017385 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17386 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17387 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017388 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17389 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17390 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17391 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17392 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17393
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017394rand([<range>]) : integer
17395 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17396 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17397 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17398 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17399 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17400
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017401uuid([<version>]) : string
17402 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17403 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17404 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17405
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017406srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17407 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17408 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17409 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17410 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17411 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017412 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17413 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17414
17415srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17416 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17417 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17418 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17419 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17420 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17421 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17422 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17423
17424 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17425 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017426
17427srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17428 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17429 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17430 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017431 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017432 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17433 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17434 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17435
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017436srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17437 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17438 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17439 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17440 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17441 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17442 fetch methods.
17443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017444srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17445 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17446 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017447 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017448 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17449 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017450 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017451 overloading servers).
17452
17453 Example :
17454 # Redirect to a separate back
17455 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17456 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17457 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17458
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017459srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017460 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17461 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17462 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17463
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017464srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017465 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17466 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17467 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17468
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017469srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017470 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17471 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17472 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17473
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017474stopping : boolean
17475 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17476 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17477 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17478
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017479str(<string>) : string
17480 Returns a string.
17481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017482table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17483 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17484 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17485
17486table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17487 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17488 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17489 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17490
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017491thread : integer
17492 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17493 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17494 and debugging purposes.
17495
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017496var(<var-name>) : undefined
17497 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017498 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17499 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017500 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017501 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17502 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017503 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017504 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17505 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017506 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017507 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017508
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175097.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017510----------------------------------
17511
17512The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17513closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17514methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17515sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17516TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017517the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17518counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017519"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17520used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17521can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17522Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17523table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17524tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17525currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017526
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017527bc_dst : ip
17528 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17529 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17530 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17531 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17532
17533bc_dst_port : integer
17534 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17535 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17536
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017537bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017538 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17539 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17540 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17541
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017542bc_src : ip
17543 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17544 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17545 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17546 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17547
17548bc_src_port : integer
17549 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17550 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17551
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017552be_id : integer
17553 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017554 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17555 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017556
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017557be_name : string
17558 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017559 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17560 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017561
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017562be_server_timeout : integer
17563 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17564 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17565 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17566
17567be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17568 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17569 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17570 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17571
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017572cur_server_timeout : integer
17573 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17574 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17575 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17576
17577cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17578 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17579 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17580 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17581
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017582dst : ip
17583 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17584 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17585 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17586 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017587 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17588 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17589 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17590 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17591 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17592 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017593
17594dst_conn : integer
17595 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17596 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17597 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17598 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17599 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17600 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17601 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17602 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017603
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017604dst_is_local : boolean
17605 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17606 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17607 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17608 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017609 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017610 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17611 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17612 it only once per connection.
17613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017614dst_port : integer
17615 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17616 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17617 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17618 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17619 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17620 an HTTP header.
17621
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017622fc_http_major : integer
17623 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17624 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17625 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17626
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017627fc_pp_authority : string
17628 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17629 if any.
17630
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017631fc_pp_unique_id : string
17632 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17633 if any.
17634
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017635fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17636 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17637 header.
17638
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017639fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17640 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17641 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17642 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17643 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17644 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17645 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17646
17647fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17648 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17649 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17650 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17651 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17652 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17653 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17654
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017655fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017656 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17657 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17658 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17659 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17660
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017661fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017662 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17663 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17664 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17665 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17666
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017667fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017668 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17669 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17670 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17671 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17672
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017673fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017674 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17675 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17676 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17677 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17678
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017679fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017680 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17681 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17682 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17683 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17684
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017685fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017686 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17687 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17688 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17689 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17690
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017691fe_defbe : string
17692 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17693 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017695fe_id : integer
17696 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017697 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017698 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17699
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017700fe_name : string
17701 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17702 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17703 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17704
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017705fe_client_timeout : integer
17706 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17707 current frontend.
17708
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017709sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017710sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17711sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17712sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017713 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17714 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17715 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17716
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017717sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017718sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17719sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17720sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017721 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17722 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17723 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17724
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017725sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017726sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17727sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17728sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017729 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17730 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017731 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17732 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17733 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017734
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017735 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017736 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17737 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017738 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17739 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17740 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017741 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17742 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17743
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017744sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17745sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17746sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17747sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17748 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17749 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17750 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17751 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17752 when a first ACL was verified.
17753
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017754sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017755sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17756sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17757sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017758 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017759 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17760
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017761sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017762sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17763sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17764sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017765 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17766 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17767 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17768
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017769sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017770sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17771sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17772sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017773 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17774 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17775 See also src_conn_rate.
17776
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017777sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017778sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17779sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17780sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017781 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017782 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017783
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017784sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17785sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17786sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17787sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17788 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17789 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17790
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017791sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17792sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17793sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17794sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17795 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17796 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17797
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017798sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017799sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17800sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17801sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017802 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17803 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17804 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017805 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17806 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17807 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017808
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017809sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17810sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17811sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17812sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17813 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17814 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17815 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17816 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17817 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17818 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17819
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017820sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017821sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17822sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17823sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017824 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017825 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17826 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17827
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017828sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017829sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17830sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17831sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017832 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17833 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17834 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17835 src_http_err_rate.
17836
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017837sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17838sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17839sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17840sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17841 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17842 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17843 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17844
17845sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17846sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17847sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17848sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17849 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17850 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17851 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17852 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17853
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017854sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017855sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17856sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17857sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017858 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017859 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17860 src_http_req_cnt.
17861
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017862sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017863sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17864sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17865sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017866 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17867 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17868 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17869 src_http_req_rate.
17870
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017871sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017872sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17873sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17874sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017875 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017876 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17877 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17878 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17879 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017880
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017881 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017882 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17883 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017884 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17885
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017886sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17887sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17888sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17889sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17890 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17891 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17892 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17893 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17894 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17895
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017896sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017897sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17898sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17899sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017900 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17901 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17902 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017903
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017904sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017905sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17906sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17907sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017908 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17909 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17910 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017911
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017912sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017913sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17914sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17915sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017916 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017917 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17918 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17919 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017920 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017921 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17922
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017923sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017924sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17925sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17926sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017927 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17928 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17929 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17930 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17931 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017932 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017933
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017934sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017935sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17936sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17937sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017938 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17939 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17940 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17941
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017942sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017943sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17944sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17945sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017946 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17947 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017948 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017949 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17950 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017951 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17952 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17953 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017954
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017955so_id : integer
17956 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17957 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17958 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017959
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017960so_name : string
17961 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17962 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17963 strings instead of integers.
17964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017965src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017966 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017967 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17968 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17969 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017970 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17971 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17972 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017973 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17974 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17975 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17976 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17977 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17978 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17979 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017980
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017981 Example:
17982 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17983 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17984
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017985src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17986 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17987 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17988 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017989 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017991src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17992 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17993 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017994 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017995 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017996
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017997src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17998 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17999 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18000 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18001 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18002 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18003 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018004
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018005 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018006 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18007 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18008 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18009 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018010 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018011 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18012 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18013
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018014src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18015 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18016 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18017 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18018 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18019 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18020 was verified.
18021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018022src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018023 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018024 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018025 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018026 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018028src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018029 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018030 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18031 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018032 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018033
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018034src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18035 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18036 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18037 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018038 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018040src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018041 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018042 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018043 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018044 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018045
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018046src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18047 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18048 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18049 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18050 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18051
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018052src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18053 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18054 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18055 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18056 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18057
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018058src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018059 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018060 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018061 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18062 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018063 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18064 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18065 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018066
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018067src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18068 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18069 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18070 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18071 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18072 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18073 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18074 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018076src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018077 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018078 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018079 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018080 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018081 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018083src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18084 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18085 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18086 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18087 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018088 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018089
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018090src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18091 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18092 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018093 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018094 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18095 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18096
18097src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18098 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18099 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18100 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18101 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18102 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18103 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18104
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018105src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018106 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018107 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18108 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018109 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018111src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18112 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18113 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18114 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018115 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018116 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018118src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18119 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18120 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18121 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018122 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018123 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18124 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018125
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018126 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018127 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018128 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018129 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018130
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018131src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18132 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18133 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18134 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18135 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18136 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18137 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18138
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018139src_is_local : boolean
18140 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18141 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18142 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18143 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018144 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018145 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18146 once per connection.
18147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018148src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018149 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18150 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18151 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18152 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18153 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018155src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018156 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18157 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18158 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18159 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18160 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018161
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018162src_port : integer
18163 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18164 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18165 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18166 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018168src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018169 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018170 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18171 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18172 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018173 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018175src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18176 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18177 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18178 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18179 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018180 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018182src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18183 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18184 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18185 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18186 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18187 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18188 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18189 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18190 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018191
18192 Example :
18193 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18194 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18195 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18196 listen ssh
18197 bind :22
18198 mode tcp
18199 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018200 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018201 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018202 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18203
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018204srv_id : integer
18205 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18206 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018207 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018208
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018209srv_name : string
18210 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18211 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018212 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018213
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200182147.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018215----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018216
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018217The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
18218closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18219when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18220usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018221future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018222
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001822351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18224 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18225 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18226 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18227 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18228 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18229
18230 Example :
18231 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18232 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18233 # the request.
18234 frontend http-in
18235 bind *:8081
18236 default_backend servers
18237 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18238 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18239
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018240ssl_bc : boolean
18241 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18242 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018243 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18244 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018245
18246ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18247 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018248 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18249 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018250
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018251ssl_bc_alpn : string
18252 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18253 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018254 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018255 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18256 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18257 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18258 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18259 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018260 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18261 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018262
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018263ssl_bc_cipher : string
18264 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018265 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18266 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018267
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018268ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18269 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18270 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18271 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018272 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018273
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018274ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18275 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18276 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018277 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18278 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018279
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018280ssl_bc_npn : string
18281 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18282 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018283 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018284 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18285 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18286 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18287 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018288 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18289 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018290
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018291ssl_bc_protocol : string
18292 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018293 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18294 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018295
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018296ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018297 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018298 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018299 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18300 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018301
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018302ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18303 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18304 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18305 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018306 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018307
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018308ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18309 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18310 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018311 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18312 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018313
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018314ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18315 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18316 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18317 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018318 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018319
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018320ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18321 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018322 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18323 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018325ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18326 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18327 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18328 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18329 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18330 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018331
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018332ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18333 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18334 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18335 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18336 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018337
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018338ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018339 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18340 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18341 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018342 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018343 does not support resumed sessions.
18344
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018345ssl_c_der : binary
18346 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18347 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18348 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018350ssl_c_err : integer
18351 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18352 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18353 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18354 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18355 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018356
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018357ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018358 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18359 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18360 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18361 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18362 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18363 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18364 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18365 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018366 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18367 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18368 LDAP v3.
18369 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18370 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018372ssl_c_key_alg : string
18373 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18374 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18375 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018376
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018377ssl_c_notafter : string
18378 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18379 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18380 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018382ssl_c_notbefore : string
18383 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18384 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18385 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018386
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018387ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018388 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18389 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18390 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18391 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18392 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18393 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18394 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18395 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018396 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18397 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18398 LDAP v3.
18399 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18400 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018401
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018402ssl_c_serial : binary
18403 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18404 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18405 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018406
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018407ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18408 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18409 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18410 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018411 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18412 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18413
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018414 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018415 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018416
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018417ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18418 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18419 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18420 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018422ssl_c_used : boolean
18423 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18424 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018425
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018426ssl_c_verify : integer
18427 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18428 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18429 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18430 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018431
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018432ssl_c_version : integer
18433 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18434 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018435
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018436ssl_f_der : binary
18437 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18438 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18439 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18440
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018441ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018442 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18443 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18444 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18445 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018446 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018447 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18448 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18449 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018450 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18451 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18452 LDAP v3.
18453 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18454 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018456ssl_f_key_alg : string
18457 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18458 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18459 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018461ssl_f_notafter : string
18462 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18463 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18464 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018465
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018466ssl_f_notbefore : string
18467 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18468 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18469 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018470
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018471ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018472 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18473 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18474 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18475 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18476 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18477 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18478 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18479 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018480 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18481 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18482 LDAP v3.
18483 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18484 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018486ssl_f_serial : binary
18487 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18488 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18489 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018490
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018491ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18492 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18493 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18494 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018496ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18497 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18498 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18499 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018500
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018501ssl_f_version : integer
18502 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18503 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18504
18505ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018506 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18507 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18508 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018510 Example :
18511 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18512 listen http-https
18513 bind :80
18514 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18515 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18516
18517ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18518 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18519 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18520
18521ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018522 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018523 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18524 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18525 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18526 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18527 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18528 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18529 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18530 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18531
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018532ssl_fc_cipher : string
18533 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18534 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018535
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018536ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18537 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18538 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018539 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018540
18541ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18542 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18543 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018544 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018545
18546ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18547 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18548 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18549 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018550 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018551 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018552
18553ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18554 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18555 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018556 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018557
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018558ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18559 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18560 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18561 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18562
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018563ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18564 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18565 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18566 transport layer.
18567 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18568 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18569 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18570 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18571
18572ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18573 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18574 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18575 transport layer.
18576 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18577 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18578 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18579 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18580
18581ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18582 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18583 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18584 transport layer.
18585 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18586 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18587 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18588 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18589
18590ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18591 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18592 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18593 transport layer.
18594 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18595 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18596 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18597 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18598
18599ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18600 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18601 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18602 transport layer.
18603 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18604 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18605 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18606 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18607
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018608ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018609 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18610 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018611 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18612 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18613 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18614 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018615
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018616ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18617 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18618 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18619 wait until the handshake happened.
18620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018621ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18622 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018623 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18624 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018625 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018626 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018627
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018628ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018629 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018630 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18631 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018633ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018634 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18636 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18637 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18638 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18639 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18640 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18641 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018642
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018643ssl_fc_protocol : string
18644 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18645 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018646
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018647ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018648 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018649 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18650 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018651
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018652ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18653 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18654 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18655 transport layer.
18656 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18657 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18658 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18659 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18660
18661ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18662 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18663 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18664 transport layer.
18665 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18666 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18667 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18668 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18669
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018670ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18671 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18672 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18673 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018675ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18676 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18677 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18678 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18679 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018680
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018681ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18682 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18683 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18684 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18685 BoringSSL.
18686
18687
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018688ssl_fc_sni : string
18689 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18690 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18691 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18692 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18693 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18694
18695 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18696 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18697 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018698 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018699 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018701 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018702 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18703 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018705ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18706 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18707 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018708
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018709ssl_s_der : binary
18710 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18711 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18712 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18713
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018714ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18715 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18716 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18717 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018718 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018719 does not support resumed sessions.
18720
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018721ssl_s_key_alg : string
18722 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18723 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18724 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18725
18726ssl_s_notafter : string
18727 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18728 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18729 transport layer.
18730
18731ssl_s_notbefore : string
18732 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18733 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18734 transport layer.
18735
18736ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18737 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18738 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18739 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18740 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18741 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18742 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018743 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18744 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018745 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18746 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18747 LDAP v3.
18748 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18749 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18750
18751ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18752 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18753 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18754 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18755 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18756 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18757 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018758 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18759 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018760 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18761 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18762 LDAP v3.
18763 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18764 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18765
18766ssl_s_serial : binary
18767 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18768 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18769 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18770
18771ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18772 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18773 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18774 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18775
18776ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18777 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18778 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18779 layer.
18780
18781ssl_s_version : integer
18782 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18783 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018784
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200187857.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018786------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018788Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18789sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18790only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18791For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18792be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18793can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18794sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18795for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18796content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018797
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018798Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18799 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18800 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18801 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18802 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18803 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18804 sample expression). So be careful.
18805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018806payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018807 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018808 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18809 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018811payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18812 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018813 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018814 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018815
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018816req.len : integer
18817req_len : integer (deprecated)
18818 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18819 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18820 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18821 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18822 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18823 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18824 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18825 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018827req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18828 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018829 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18830 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18831 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18832 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018833
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018834 ACL alternatives :
18835 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018837req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18838 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18839 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18840 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18841 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018842
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018843 ACL alternatives :
18844 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018845
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018846 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018848req.proto_http : boolean
18849req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18850 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18851 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18852 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18853 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18854 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18855 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18856 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018858 Example:
18859 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18860 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18861 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018862 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018864req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18865rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18866 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18867 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18868 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18869 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18870 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18871 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18872 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018874 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18875 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18876 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18877 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18878 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18879 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018881 ACL derivatives :
18882 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018883
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018884 Example :
18885 listen tse-farm
18886 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18887 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18888 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18889 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18890 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18891 persist rdp-cookie
18892 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18893 # This is only useful makes sense if
18894 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18895 stick-table type string size 204800
18896 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18897 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18898 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018899
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018900 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18901 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018902
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018903req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18904rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18905 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18906 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18907 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18908 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018910 ACL derivatives :
18911 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018912
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018913req.ssl_alpn : string
18914 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18915 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18916 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18917 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18918 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18919 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018920 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018921
18922 Examples :
18923 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18924 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18925 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018926 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018927 default_backend bk_default
18928
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018929req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18930 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18931 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018932 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18933 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18934 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18935 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18936 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018938req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18939req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18940 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18941 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18942 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18943 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18944 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18945 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18946 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018948req.ssl_sni : string
18949req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18950 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18951 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18952 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18953 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18954 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018955 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18956 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18957 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18958 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18959 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18960 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18961 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18962 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18963 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018964
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018965 ACL derivatives :
18966 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018968 Examples :
18969 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18970 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18971 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18972 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18973 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018974
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018975req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18976 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18977 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18978 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18979 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18980 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18981 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18982 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18983 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18984 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018986req.ssl_ver : integer
18987req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18988 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18989 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18990 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18991 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18992 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18993 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18994 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018995 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018996 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018997
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018998 ACL derivatives :
18999 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019000
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019001res.len : integer
19002 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19003 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19004 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19005 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19006 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
19007 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
19008 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019009 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019011res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19012 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019013 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019014 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019015 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019016 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019018res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19019 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19020 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19021 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019022 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19023 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019024
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019025 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019026
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019027res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19028rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19029 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19030 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19031 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19032 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19033 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19034 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19035 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019037wait_end : boolean
19038 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19039 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019040 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019041 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19042 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019043 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019044 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19045 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019047 Examples :
19048 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19049 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19050 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019052 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19053 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19054 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19055 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19056 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19057 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19058 tcp-request content reject
19059
19060
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200190617.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019062--------------------------------------
19063
19064It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19065This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19066data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19067its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19068HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19069content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19070to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19071more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19072response are indexed.
19073
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019074Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19075 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19076 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19077 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19078 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19079 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19080 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19081
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019082base : string
19083 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19084 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19085 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19086 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19087 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19088 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19089 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19090 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19091
19092 ACL derivatives :
19093 base : exact string match
19094 base_beg : prefix match
19095 base_dir : subdir match
19096 base_dom : domain match
19097 base_end : suffix match
19098 base_len : length match
19099 base_reg : regex match
19100 base_sub : substring match
19101
19102base32 : integer
19103 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19104 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19105 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019106 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19107 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19108 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019109
19110base32+src : binary
19111 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19112 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19113 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19114 per-URL counters.
19115
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019116baseq : string
19117 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19118 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19119 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19120 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19121
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019122capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19123 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19124 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19125 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19126
19127capture.req.method : string
19128 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19129 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19130 because it's allocated.
19131
19132capture.req.uri : string
19133 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19134 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19135 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19136 allocated.
19137
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019138capture.req.ver : string
19139 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19140 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19141 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19142
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019143capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19144 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19145 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19146 The first entry is an index of 0.
19147 See also: "capture response header"
19148
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019149capture.res.ver : string
19150 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19151 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19152 persistent flag.
19153
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019154req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019155 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19156 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19157 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019158
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019159req.body_param([<name>) : string
19160 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19161 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19162 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19163 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19164 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19165 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19166 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19167 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19168 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19169 given.
19170
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019171req.body_len : integer
19172 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19173 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019174 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19175 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019176
19177req.body_size : integer
19178 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019179 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19180 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019181
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019182req.cook([<name>]) : string
19183cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19184 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19185 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19186 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19187 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19188 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19189 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19190 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19191 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19192
19193 ACL derivatives :
19194 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19195 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19196 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19197 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19198 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19199 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19200 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19201 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019203req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19204cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19205 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19206 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019208req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19209cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19210 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19211 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19212 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19213 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019215cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19216 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19217 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19218 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19219 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019220 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019221 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19222 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19223 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19224 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019225
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019226hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19227 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19228 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19229 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19230 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019231 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019233req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019234 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19235 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19236 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19237 with headers such as User-Agent.
19238
19239 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19240 found.
19241
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019242 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19243 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19244 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019245 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019246
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019247req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19248 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19249 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019250 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19251 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019252
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019253req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019254 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19255 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19256 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19257 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19258 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19259 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19260 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19261
19262 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19263 found.
19264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019265 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19266 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19267 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019268 with -1 being the last one.
19269
19270 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19271 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019272
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019273 ACL derivatives :
19274 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19275 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19276 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19277 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19278 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19279 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19280 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19281 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19282
19283req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19284hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19285 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19286 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019287 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19288 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19289 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19290
19291 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19292 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19293 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19294
19295 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019296
19297req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19298hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19299 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19300 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19301 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019302 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19303 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19304 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19305 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19306 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019307
19308 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19309
19310 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019311
19312req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19313hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19314 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19315 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19316 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019317
19318 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19319
19320 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019321
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019322req.hdrs : string
19323 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19324 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19325 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19326 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19327
19328req.hdrs_bin : binary
19329 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19330 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19331 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19332 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19333 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19334 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19335
19336 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019337
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019338 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19339 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019340
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019341http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19342 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19343 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19344 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19345 basic auth is supported.
19346
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019347http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19348 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19349 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19350 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19351 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019352 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19353 basic auth is supported.
19354
19355 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019356 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19357 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19358 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19359 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019360
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019361http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019362 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19363 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19364 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019365
19366http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019367 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19368 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19369 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019370
19371http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019372 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19373 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19374 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019375
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019376http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019377 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19378 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019379 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19380 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019382method : integer + string
19383 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19384 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19385 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19386 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19387 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19388 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19389 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019390
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019391 ACL derivatives :
19392 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019393
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019394 Example :
19395 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19396 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19397 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019399path : string
19400 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19401 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19402 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19403 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19404 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019405 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019406 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019408 ACL derivatives :
19409 path : exact string match
19410 path_beg : prefix match
19411 path_dir : subdir match
19412 path_dom : domain match
19413 path_end : suffix match
19414 path_len : length match
19415 path_reg : regex match
19416 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019417
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019418pathq : string
19419 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19420 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19421 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19422 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19423 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19424 result in both cases.
19425
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019426query : string
19427 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19428 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19429 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19430 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019431 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019432 which stops before the question mark.
19433
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019434req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19435 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19436 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19437 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19438 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19439
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019440req.ver : string
19441req_ver : string (deprecated)
19442 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19443 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19444 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019446 ACL derivatives :
19447 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019448
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019449res.body : binary
19450 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19451 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019452 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19453
19454 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019455
19456res.body_len : integer
19457 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19458 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019459 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19460
19461 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019462
19463res.body_size : integer
19464 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19465 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19466 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19467 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019468 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19469
19470 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019471
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019472res.cache_hit : boolean
19473 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19474 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19475
19476res.cache_name : string
19477 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19478 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19479 empty string.
19480
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019481res.comp : boolean
19482 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19483 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19484 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019485
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019486res.comp_algo : string
19487 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19488 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19489 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019490
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019491res.cook([<name>]) : string
19492scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19493 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19494 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019495 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19496
19497 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019498
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019499 ACL derivatives :
19500 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019501
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019502res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19503scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19504 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19505 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019506 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19507
19508 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019510res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19511scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19512 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19513 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019514 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19515
19516 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019517
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019518res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019519 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19520 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19521
19522 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19523 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19524
19525 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19526
19527 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019528
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019529res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019530 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19531 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19532
19533 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19534 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19535
19536 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019537
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019538res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19539shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019540 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19541 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19542
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019543 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019544 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19545
19546 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019547
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019548 ACL derivatives :
19549 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19550 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19551 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19552 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19553 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19554 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19555 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19556 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19557
19558res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19559shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019560 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19561 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19562
19563 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019564 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019565
19566 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019568res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19569shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019570 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19571 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19572
19573 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19574
19575 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019576
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019577res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19578 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19579 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19580 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019581 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19582
19583 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019585res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19586shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019587 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19588 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19589
19590 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19591
19592 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019593
19594res.hdrs : string
19595 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19596 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19597 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019598 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19599
19600 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019601
19602res.hdrs_bin : binary
19603 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19604 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19605 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19606 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19607 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19608 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19609 (length of 0 for both).
19610
19611 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19612
19613 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19614 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019615
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019616res.ver : string
19617resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19618 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019619 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19620
19621 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019623 ACL derivatives :
19624 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019625
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019626set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19627 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19628 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019629 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019630 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019631
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019632 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19633 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019634
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019635status : integer
19636 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19637 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019638 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19639
19640 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019641
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019642unique-id : string
19643 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19644 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19645 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19646 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19647 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19648 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019650url : string
19651 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19652 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19653 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19654 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19655 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19656 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19657 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019659 ACL derivatives :
19660 url : exact string match
19661 url_beg : prefix match
19662 url_dir : subdir match
19663 url_dom : domain match
19664 url_end : suffix match
19665 url_len : length match
19666 url_reg : regex match
19667 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019668
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019669url_ip : ip
19670 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19671 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19672 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19673 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19674 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19675 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19676 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019677
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019678url_port : integer
19679 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19680 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19681 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19682 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019683
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019684urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19685url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019686 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19687 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019688 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19689 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19690 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19691 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019692 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19693 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019694 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19695 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019697 ACL derivatives :
19698 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19699 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19700 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19701 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19702 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19703 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19704 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19705 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019706
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019707
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019708 Example :
19709 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19710 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19711 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19712 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019713
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019714urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019715 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19716 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19717 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019718
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019719url32 : integer
19720 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19721 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19722 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19723 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19724 is an unsigned integer.
19725
19726url32+src : binary
19727 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19728 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19729 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19730
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019731
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200197327.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019733---------------------------------------
19734
19735This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19736used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19737purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19738There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19739or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19740any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19741for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19742
19743internal.htx.data : integer
19744 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19745 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19746
19747internal.htx.free : integer
19748 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19749 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19750
19751internal.htx.free_data : integer
19752 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19753 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19754
19755internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019756 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19757 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19758 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019759
19760internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19761 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19762 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19763
19764internal.htx.size : integer
19765 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19766 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19767
19768internal.htx.used : integer
19769 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19770 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19771 direction.
19772
19773internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19774 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19775 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19776 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19777 of the special value :
19778 * head : The oldest inserted block
19779 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019780 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019781
19782internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19783 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19784 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19785 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19786 integer or one of the special value :
19787 * head : The oldest inserted block
19788 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019789 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019790
19791internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19792 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19793 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19794 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19795 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19796
19797 * head : The oldest inserted block
19798 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019799 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019800
19801internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19802 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19803 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19804 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19805 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19806
19807 * head : The oldest inserted block
19808 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019809 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019810
19811internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19812 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19813 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19814 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19815 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19816
19817 * head : The oldest inserted block
19818 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019819 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019820
19821internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19822 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19823 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19824 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19825 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19826
19827 * head : The oldest inserted block
19828 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019829 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019830
19831internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19832 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19833 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19834 it returns false.
19835
19836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200198377.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019838---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019839
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019840Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19841every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019842order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019843
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019844ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019845---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19846FALSE always_false never match
19847HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19848HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19849HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019850HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019851HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19852HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19853HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19854HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19855LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19856METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19857METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19858METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19859METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19860METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19861METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19862METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19863METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19864RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19865REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19866TRUE always_true always match
19867WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19868---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019869
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019870
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200198718. Logging
19872----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019873
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019874One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19875provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19876very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19877provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19878state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019879to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019880headers.
19881
19882In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19883about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19884send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19885
19886 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19887 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19888 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19889 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19890 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019891 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019892 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019893
19894The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19895allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19896as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19897while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19898real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19899delay.
19900
19901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199028.1. Log levels
19903---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019904
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019905TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019906source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019907HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19908in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19909track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19910syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19911about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019912
19913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199148.2. Log formats
19915----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019916
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019917HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019918and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19919slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19920options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019921
19922 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19923 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19924 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19925 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19926 extents.
19927
19928 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19929 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19930 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19931 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19932 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19933
19934 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19935 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19936 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19937 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19938 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19939
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019940 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19941 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19942 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19943 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19944
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019945 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19946
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019947Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19948specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19949field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19950servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19951always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19952identifier.
19953
19954Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19955 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19956 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19957 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19958 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19959
19960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199618.2.1. Default log format
19962-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019963
19964This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19965as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19966format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19967
19968 Example :
19969 listen www
19970 mode http
19971 log global
19972 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19973
19974 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19975 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19976 (www/HTTP)
19977
19978 Field Format Extract from the example above
19979 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19980 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19981 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19982 4 'to' to
19983 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19984 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19985
19986Detailed fields description :
19987 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19988 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19989 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19990 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19991 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19992 and processed the connection.
19993 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19994
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019995In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19996"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19997connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19998
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019999It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20000will eventually disappear.
20001
20002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200038.2.2. TCP log format
20004---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020005
20006The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20007is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20008information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20009counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20010emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20011environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20012the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20013sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020014specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20015not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20016fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20017marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020018
20019 Example :
20020 frontend fnt
20021 mode tcp
20022 option tcplog
20023 log global
20024 default_backend bck
20025
20026 backend bck
20027 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20028
20029 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20030 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20031 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20032
20033 Field Format Extract from the example above
20034 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20035 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20036 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20037 4 frontend_name fnt
20038 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20039 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20040 7 bytes_read* 212
20041 8 termination_state --
20042 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20043 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20044
20045Detailed fields description :
20046 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020047 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20048 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20049 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020050 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020051 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020052 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020053
20054 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020055 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20056 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20057 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020058
20059 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
20060 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20061 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020062 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20063 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20064 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20065 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020066
20067 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20068 and processed the connection.
20069
20070 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20071 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20072 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20073 applications.
20074
20075 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20076 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20077 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20078 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20079 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20080
20081 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20082 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20083 See "Timers" below for more details.
20084
20085 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20086 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20087 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20088 "Timers" below for more details.
20089
20090 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020091 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020092 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20093 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20094 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20095 details.
20096
20097 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20098 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20099 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20100 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20101 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20102
20103 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20104 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20105 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20106 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20107 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20108 for more details.
20109
20110 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020111 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020112 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20113 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20114 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020115 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020116
20117 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20118 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20119 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20120 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20121 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20122 caused by a denial of service attack.
20123
20124 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20125 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20126 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20127 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20128 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20129 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20130 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20131 denial of service attack.
20132
20133 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20134 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20135 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20136 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20137 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20138 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20139 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20140 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20141 be processed than on other servers.
20142
20143 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20144 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20145 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20146 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20147 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20148 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20149 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20150 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20151 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20152 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20153 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20154 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20155 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20156
20157 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20158 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20159 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20160 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20161 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20162 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020163 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020164 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20165
20166 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20167 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20168 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20169 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20170 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20171 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020172 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020173 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20174 occurs.
20175
20176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201778.2.3. HTTP log format
20178----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020179
20180The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20181is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20182the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20183are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20184emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20185generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20186"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20187which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020188frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20189is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020190
20191Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20192slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20193with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20194
20195 Example :
20196 frontend http-in
20197 mode http
20198 option httplog
20199 log global
20200 default_backend bck
20201
20202 backend static
20203 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20204
20205 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20206 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20207 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020208 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020209
20210 Field Format Extract from the example above
20211 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20212 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020213 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020214 4 frontend_name http-in
20215 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020216 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020217 7 status_code 200
20218 8 bytes_read* 2750
20219 9 captured_request_cookie -
20220 10 captured_response_cookie -
20221 11 termination_state ----
20222 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20223 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20224 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20225 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20226 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020227
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020228Detailed fields description :
20229 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020230 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
20231 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20232 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020233 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020234 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020235 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020236
20237 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020238 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20239 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20240 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020241
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020242 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
20243 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020244
20245 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20246 and processed the connection.
20247
20248 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20249 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20250 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20251
20252 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20253 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20254 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20255 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20256 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20257 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20258
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020259 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20260 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20261 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020262 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020263 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20264 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020265 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20266 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020267
20268 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20269 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020270 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020271
20272 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20273 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020274 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20275 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020276
20277 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20278 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20279 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20280 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20281 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020282 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20283 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020284
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020285 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20286 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20287 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20288 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20289 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20290 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20291 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020292 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020293
20294 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20295 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20296 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20297
20298 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20299 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020300 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020301 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20302 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20303 overflowing.
20304
20305 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20306 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20307 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20308 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20309 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20310 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20311 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20312 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20313
20314 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20315 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20316 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20317 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20318 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20319 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20320 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20321 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20322
20323 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20324 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20325 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20326 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20327 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20328 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20329 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20330
20331 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020332 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020333 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20334 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20335 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020336 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020337 system.
20338
20339 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20340 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20341 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20342 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20343 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20344 caused by a denial of service attack.
20345
20346 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20347 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20348 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20349 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20350 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20351 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20352 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20353 denial of service attack.
20354
20355 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20356 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20357 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20358 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20359 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20360 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20361 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20362 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20363 processed than on other servers.
20364
20365 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20366 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20367 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20368 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20369 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20370 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20371 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20372 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20373 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20374 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20375 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20376 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20377 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20378
20379 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20380 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20381 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20382 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20383 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20384 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020385 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020386 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20387
20388 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20389 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20390 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20391 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20392 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20393 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020394 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020395 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20396 occurs.
20397
20398 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20399 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20400 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20401 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20402 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20403 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20404 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20405 cookies" below for more details.
20406
20407 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20408 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20409 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20410 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20411 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20412 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20413 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20414 and cookies" below for more details.
20415
20416 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20417 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20418 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20419 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20420 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20421 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20422 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20423 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20424
20425
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200204268.2.4. Custom log format
20427------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020428
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020429The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020430mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020431
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020432HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020433Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20434separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20435prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20436
20437Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20438variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020439("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020440
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020441If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020442as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020443less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20444the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20445
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020446Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20447"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20448delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20449preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020450
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020451Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20452'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20453https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20454such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20455
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020456Flags are :
20457 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020458 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020459 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20460 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020461
20462 Example:
20463
20464 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20465 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20466
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020467 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20468
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020469At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20470
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020471 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20472 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020473
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020474the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020475
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020476 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20477 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20478 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020479
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020480and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20481
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020482 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20483 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020484
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020485Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20486
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020487 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020488 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020489 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20490 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20491 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020492 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20493 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20494 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020495 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020496 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020497 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020498 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020499 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020500 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20501 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020502 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020503 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020504 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020505 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020506 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020507 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020508 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020509 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20510 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20511 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20512 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20513 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020514 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020515 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020516 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020517 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020518 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020519 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20520 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020521 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20522 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20523 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020524 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020525 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20526 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020527 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020528 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20529 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20530 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020531 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020532 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020533 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20534 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20535 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20536 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020537 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020538 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020539 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020540 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020541 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020542 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020543 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20544 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20545 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020546 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020547 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20548 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020549 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020550 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20551 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020552 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020553 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020554 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020555 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020556
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020557 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020558
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020559
205608.2.5. Error log format
20561-----------------------
20562
20563When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20564protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20565By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20566"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020567will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020568logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20569
20570The format looks like this :
20571
20572 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20573 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20574 Connection error during SSL handshake
20575
20576 Field Format Extract from the example above
20577 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20578 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20579 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20580 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20581 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20582
20583These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20584failures.
20585
20586
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205878.3. Advanced logging options
20588-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020589
20590Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20591just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20592options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20593for more information about their usage.
20594
20595
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200205968.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20597------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020598
20599It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20600haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20601commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20602monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20603ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20604
20605 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20606 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20607 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20608 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20609
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020610 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20611 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020612
20613 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20614 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20615 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20616
20617
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206188.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20619----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020620
20621The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20622what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20623or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020624"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020625just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20626log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20627after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20628is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20629with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20630with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20631
20632
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206338.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20634------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020635
20636Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20637for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20638"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20639retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20640raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20641a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20642file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20643you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20644"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20645
20646
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206478.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20648--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020649
20650Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20651multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20652them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20653"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20654logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20655error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20656and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20657too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20658useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20659alternative.
20660
20661
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206628.4. Timing events
20663------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020664
20665Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20666reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20667the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20668frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020669mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20670addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20671
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020672Timings events in HTTP mode:
20673
20674 first request 2nd request
20675 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20676 t tr t tr ...
20677 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20678 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20679 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20680 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020681 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020682 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20683
20684Timings events in TCP mode:
20685
20686 TCP session
20687 |<----------------->|
20688 t t
20689 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20690 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20691 |<------ Tt ------->|
20692
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020693 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020694 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020695 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20696 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20697 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020698 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020699 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20700 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20701 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20702 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020703
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020704 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20705 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20706 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020707 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20708 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20709 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20710 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20711 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20712 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020713
20714 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20715 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20716 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20717 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20718 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20719 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20720 request typed by hand during a test.
20721
20722 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20723 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020724 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020725 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20726 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20727 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20728 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020729
20730 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20731 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20732 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20733 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20734 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20735
20736 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20737 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20738 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20739 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20740 connection never established.
20741
20742 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20743 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20744 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20745 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20746 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20747 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20748 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20749 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20750 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20751 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20752 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20753
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020754 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20755 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20756 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20757 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20758 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20759 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20760
20761 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20762
20763 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20764 "Ta" can never be negative.
20765
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020766 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20767 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020768 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20769 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020770 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020771
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020772 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020773
20774 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020775 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20776 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020777
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020778 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20779 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20780 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20781 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20782 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20783 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20784 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20785 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20786
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020787These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20788protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20789that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020790due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20791"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20792that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020793
20794Most common cases :
20795
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020796 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20797 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20798 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20799 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20800 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20801 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20802 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20803 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20804 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20805 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20806 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020807 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020808
20809 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20810 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20811 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20812 of ms on remote networks.
20813
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020814 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20815 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20816 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020817
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020818 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20819 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20820 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20821 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20822 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20823 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20824 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20825 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20826 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020827
20828Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20829
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020830 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020831 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020832 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020833
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020834 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020835 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20836 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20837
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020838 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020839 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20840 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20841 flags.
20842
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020843 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20844 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020845 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20846 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20847 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20848 the client connection was maintained open.
20849
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020850 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020851 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020852 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020853 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20854
20855
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208568.5. Session state at disconnection
20857-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020858
20859TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20860"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
208612-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20862each of which has a special meaning :
20863
20864 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20865 session to terminate :
20866
20867 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20868
20869 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20870 server explicitly refused it.
20871
20872 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20873 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20874 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20875 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020876 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020877
20878 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20879 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020880
20881 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20882 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20883 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20884 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20885 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20886
20887 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20888 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20889 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20890 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20891 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20892
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020893 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20894 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20895
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020896 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20897 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20898 backup connections when going up.
20899
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020900 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20901
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020902 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20903 send or receive data.
20904
20905 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20906 send or receive data.
20907
20908 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20909 with nothing left in the buffers.
20910
20911 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20912
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020913 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020914 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20915
20916 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20917 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20918 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20919 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20920 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20921
20922 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20923 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20924
20925 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20926 server (HTTP only).
20927
20928 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20929
20930 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20931 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20932 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20933
20934 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20935 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20936 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20937
20938 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20939
20940 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20941 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20942
20943 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20944 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20945 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20946
20947 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20948 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020949 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20950 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020951
20952 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20953 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20954 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20955 another server.
20956
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020957 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020958 server.
20959
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020960 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20961 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20962 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20963 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20964
20965 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20966 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20967 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20968 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20969
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020970 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20971 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20972 "use-server" rule).
20973
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020974 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20975
20976 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20977 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20978
20979 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20980
20981 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20982 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20983 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20984
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020985 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20986 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020987 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020988 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20989 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20990
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020991 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20992
20993 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20994 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20995
20996 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20997
20998 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20999
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021000The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21001was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021002helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21003starvation, attacks, etc...
21004
21005The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21006alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21007easier finding and understanding.
21008
21009 Flags Reason
21010
21011 -- Normal termination.
21012
21013 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
21014 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
21015 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
21016 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21017
21018 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21019 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
21020 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21021 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
21022 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21023 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021024
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021025 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21026 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021027 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021028
21029 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21030 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21031 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21032
21033 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21034 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21035 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21036 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21037 the server takes too long to respond.
21038
21039 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21040 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21041 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21042 long a time to respond.
21043
21044 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21045 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21046 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
21047 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021048 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21049 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021050
21051 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21052 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21053 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21054 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21055 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021056 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021057 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21058 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21059 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21060 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21061 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21062 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21063 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21064 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021065 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021066 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21067 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21068 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021069
21070 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21071 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021072 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21073 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21074 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21075 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021076
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021077 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
21078 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21079
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021080 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021081 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21082 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021083 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021084 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21085 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21086
21087 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21088 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21089 503 or 504 here.
21090
21091 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
21092 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
21093 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21094 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21095 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21096
21097 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21098 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021099 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021100 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
21101 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
21102
21103 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21104 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21105 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21106 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21107 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21108 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
21109 between haproxy and the server.
21110
21111 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21112 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21113 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21114 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21115 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21116 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21117 solution is to fix the application.
21118
21119 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21120 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21121 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21122 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21123 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21124 external attacks.
21125
21126 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021127 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021128 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021129 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21130 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21131
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021132 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21133 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21134 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021135 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021136 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021137
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021138 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21139 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21140 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21141 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021142 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21143 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21144 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21145 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
21146 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021147
21148 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21149 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21150 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
21151 returned an HTTP 403 error.
21152
21153 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21154 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21155 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21156 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21157
21158 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21159 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21160 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21161 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21162
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021163The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
21164persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
21165important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21166re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21167
21168 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21169
21170 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21171 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21172 set on a GET request.
21173
21174 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21175 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021176 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021177 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21178
21179 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21180 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21181 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21182
21183 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21184 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21185 already got a cookie.
21186
21187 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21188 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21189 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21190 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21191 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21192
21193 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21194 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21195 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21196
21197 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21198 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21199 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21200
21201 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21202 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21203
21204 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21205 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21206 then advertised in the response.
21207
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021208
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212098.6. Non-printable characters
21210-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021211
21212In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21213consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21214converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21215prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21216being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21217escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21218is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21219'}' when logging headers.
21220
21221Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21222issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21223containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21224
21225Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21226the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21227performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21228
21229
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212308.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21231---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021232
21233Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21234achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021235section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021236cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21237the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21238the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021239locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021240not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21241user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21242a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21243wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21244
21245 Examples :
21246 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21247 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21248
21249 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21250 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21251
21252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212538.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21254---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021255
21256Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21257proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21258the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21259server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21260
21261Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21262response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021263section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021264
21265It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021266time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21267appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021268are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21269and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21270follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21271request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21272in the logs.
21273
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021274As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21275frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21276an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21277
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021278 Example :
21279 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21280 listen proxy-out
21281 mode http
21282 option httplog
21283 option logasap
21284 log global
21285 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21286
21287 # log the name of the virtual server
21288 capture request header Host len 20
21289
21290 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21291 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21292
21293 # log the beginning of the referrer
21294 capture request header Referer len 20
21295
21296 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21297 capture response header Server len 20
21298
21299 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21300 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21301
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021302 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021303 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21304
21305 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21306 capture response header Via len 20
21307
21308 # log the URL location during a redirection
21309 capture response header Location len 20
21310
21311 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21312 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21313 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21314 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21315 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21316
21317 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21318 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21319 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21320 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021321 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021322
21323 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21324 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21325 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21326 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21327 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021328 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021329
21330
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213318.9. Examples of logs
21332---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021333
21334These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21335them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21336reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21337
21338 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21339 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21340 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21341
21342 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21343 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21344
21345 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21346 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21347 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21348
21349 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21350 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21351
21352 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21353 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21354 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21355
21356 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021357 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021358 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21359 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21360
21361 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21362 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21363 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21364
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021365 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21366 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21367 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21368 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21369 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21370 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021371
21372 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021373 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021374
21375 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21376 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21377 Nothing was sent to any server.
21378
21379 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21380 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21381
21382 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21383 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021384 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021385 send a 408 return code to the client.
21386
21387 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21388 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21389
21390 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21391 5 seconds ("c----").
21392
21393 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21394 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021395 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021396
21397 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021398 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021399 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21400 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21401 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21402 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21403 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021404
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021405
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200214069. Supported filters
21407--------------------
21408
21409Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21410accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21411unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21412
21413See also : "filter"
21414
214159.1. Trace
21416----------
21417
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021418filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021419
21420 Arguments:
21421 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21422 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21423
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021424 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021425
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021426 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021427 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21428 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21429 amount of the parsed data.
21430
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021431 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021432
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021433This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21434callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21435information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21436filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21437
21438Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21439tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21440a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21441
21442
214439.2. HTTP compression
21444---------------------
21445
21446filter compression
21447
21448The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21449keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021450when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21451fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21452done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21453explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21454filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21455listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21456order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021457
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021458See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21459 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021460
21461
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200214629.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21463--------------------------------------------
21464
21465filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21466
21467 Arguments :
21468
21469 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21470 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21471 parsed.
21472
21473 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21474 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21475 part must be placed in its own scope.
21476
21477The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21478external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021479streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021480exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21481also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21482
21483SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21484the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21485
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021486For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021487"doc/SPOE.txt".
21488
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100214899.4. Cache
21490----------
21491
21492filter cache <name>
21493
21494 Arguments :
21495
21496 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21497
21498The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21499"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021500cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021501other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21502case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21503is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21504filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021505listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21506order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021507
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021508See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21509 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21510
21511
215129.5. Fcgi-app
21513-------------
21514
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021515filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021516
21517 Arguments :
21518
21519 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21520
21521The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21522request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21523reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21524used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21525implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21526used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21527fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21528used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21529order.
21530
21531See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21532 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21533
21534
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100215359.6. OpenTracing
21536----------------
21537
21538The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21539HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21540of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21541Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21542
21543This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21544
21545The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21546HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21547participates in the work of HAProxy.
21548
21549filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21550
21551 Arguments :
21552
21553 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21554 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21555 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21556 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21557 OpenTracing filters.
21558
21559 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21560 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21561 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21562 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21563 filter must have its own scope defined.
21564
21565More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021566of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021567
21568
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002156910. FastCGI applications
21570-------------------------
21571
21572HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21573feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21574the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21575FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21576servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21577FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21578backend.
21579
21580HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21581application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21582connection.
21583
2158410.1. Setup
21585-----------
21586
2158710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21588--------------------------
21589
21590fcgi-app <name>
21591 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21592 document root must be defined.
21593
21594acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21595 Declare or complete an access list.
21596
21597 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21598 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21599 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21600 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21601 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21602
21603docroot <path>
21604 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21605 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21606 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21607
21608index <script-name>
21609 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21610 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21611 is an optional setting.
21612
21613 Example :
21614 index index.php
21615
21616log-stderr global
21617log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021618 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021619 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21620
21621 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21622 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21623
21624pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21625 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21626 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21627 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21628
21629 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21630 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21631 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21632 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21633
21634 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21635 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21636
21637path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021638 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021639 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21640 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21641 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21642 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21643 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21644 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21645 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021646
21647 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021648 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021649 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21650 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21651 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21652 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021653
21654 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021655 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21656 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021657
21658option get-values
21659no option get-values
21660 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21661
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021662 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021663 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21664
21665 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21666 application will accept.
21667
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021668 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21669 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021670
21671 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021672 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021673 option is disabled.
21674
21675 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21676 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21677 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21678 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21679 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21680 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21681
21682option keep-conn
21683no option keep-conn
21684 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21685 sending a response.
21686
21687 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21688 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21689
21690option max-reqs <reqs>
21691 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21692 accept.
21693
21694 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21695 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21696 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21697 to 1.
21698
21699option mpxs-conns
21700no option mpxs-conns
21701 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21702
21703 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21704 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21705
21706set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21707 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21708 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21709 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21710 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21711
21712 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21713 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21714 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21715
21716 Example :
21717 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21718 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21719
21720 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21721
21722
2172310.1.2. Proxy section
21724---------------------
21725
21726use-fcgi-app <name>
21727 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21728
21729 Arguments :
21730 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21731
21732 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21733 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21734 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21735 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21736 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21737
21738 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21739 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21740 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21741 application are evaluated.
21742
21743
2174410.1.3. Example
21745---------------
21746
21747 frontend front-http
21748 mode http
21749 bind *:80
21750 bind *:
21751
21752 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21753 default_backend back-static
21754
21755 backend back-static
21756 mode http
21757 server www A.B.C.D:80
21758
21759 backend back-dynamic
21760 mode http
21761 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21762 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21763
21764 fcgi-app php-fpm
21765 log-stderr global
21766 option keep-conn
21767
21768 docroot /var/www/my-app
21769 index index.php
21770 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21771
21772
2177310.2. Default parameters
21774------------------------
21775
21776A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21777the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021778script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021779applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21780
21781 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21782 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21783 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21784 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21785 | | |
21786 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21787 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21788 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21789 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21790 | | application. |
21791 | | |
21792 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21793 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21794 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21795 | | |
21796 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21797 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21798 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21799 | | the application's configuration. |
21800 | | |
21801 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21802 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21803 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21804 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21805 | | |
21806 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21807 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21808 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21809 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21810 | | be defined. |
21811 | | |
21812 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21813 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21814 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21815 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21816 | | is not set too. |
21817 | | |
21818 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21819 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21820 | | set. |
21821 | | |
21822 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21823 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21824 | | the request. |
21825 | | |
21826 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21827 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21828 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21829 | | |
21830 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21831 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21832 | | script to process the request. |
21833 | | |
21834 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21835 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21836 | | |
21837 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21838 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21839 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21840 | | |
21841 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21842 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21843 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21844 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21845 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21846 | | |
21847 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21848 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21849 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21850 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21851 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21852 | | side. |
21853 | | |
21854 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21855 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21856 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21857 | | connected to. |
21858 | | |
21859 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21860 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21861 | | |
21862 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21863 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21864 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21865 | | |
21866 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21867
21868
2186910.3. Limitations
21870------------------
21871
21872The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21873way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21874during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21875establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21876application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21877or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21878message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21879these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21880and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21881
21882Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21883request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21884requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21885
21886About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21887into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21888fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21889"http-request" ones.
21890
21891Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21892FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21893processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21894must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21895here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021896
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021897
2189811. Address formats
21899-------------------
21900
21901Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21902address.
21903
21904This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21905The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21906of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21907equivalent is '::'.
21908
21909Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21910is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21911
21912This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21913family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21914
21915Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21916configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21917use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21918'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21919
21920Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21921socket type and the transport method.
21922
21923
2192411.1 Address family prefixes
21925----------------------------
21926
21927'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21928
21929'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21930 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21931 listening.
21932
21933'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21934 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21935 on the statement using this address, a port or
21936 a port range may or must be specified.
21937
21938'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21939 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21940 using this address, a port or a port range
21941 may or must be specified.
21942
21943'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21944 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21945 using this address, a port or a port range
21946 may or must be specified.
21947
21948'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21949 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21950 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21951 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21952 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21953 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21954
21955'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21956 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21957 start by slash '/'.
21958
21959
2196011.2 Socket type prefixes
21961-------------------------
21962
21963Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21964type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21965this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21966This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21967but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21968
21969Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21970instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21971
21972If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21973they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21974report this to the maintainers.
21975
21976'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21977 to "stream"
21978
21979'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21980 to "datagram".
21981
21982
2198311.3 Protocol prefixes
21984----------------------
21985
21986'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21987 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21988 socket type and transport method is forced to
21989 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21990 this address, a port or a port range can or
21991 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21992 of 'stream+ip@'.
21993
21994'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21995 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21996 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21997 statement using this address, a port or port
21998 range can or must be specified.
21999 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22000
22001'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22002 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22003 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22004 statement using this address, a port or port
22005 range can or must be specified.
22006 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22007
22008'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22009 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22010 socket type and transport method is forced to
22011 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22012 this address, a port or a port range can or
22013 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22014 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22015
22016'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22017 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22018 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22019 the statement using this address, a port or
22020 port range can or must be specified.
22021 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22022
22023'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22024 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22025 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22026 the statement using this address, a port or
22027 port range can or must be specified.
22028 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22029
22030'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22031 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22032 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22033
22034'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22035 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22036 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22037
22038In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22039QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22040
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022041/*
22042 * Local variables:
22043 * fill-column: 79
22044 * End:
22045 */